LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Add to my manuals
264 Pages

advertisement

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide | Manualzz

LibreOffice 4.0

Impress Guide

Presentations in LibreOffice

Copyright

This document is Copyright © 2011–2013 by its contributors as listed below. You may distribute it and/or modify it under the terms of either the GNU General Public License

( http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html

), version 3 or later, or the Creative Commons Attribution

License ( http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/3.0/ ), version 3.0 or later. All trademarks in this guide belong to their legitimate owners.

Contributors

Peter Schofield

T. Elliot Turner

Low Song Chuan

Michele Zarri

Chad D. Lines

Jaimon Jacob

Jean Hollis Weber

Muhammad Sufyan Zainalabidin

Hazel Russman

Feedback

Please direct any comments or suggestions about this document to: [email protected]

Acknowledgments

This book is adapted and updated from the OpenOffice.org 3.3 Impress Guide. The contributors to

that book are listed on page 11.

Publication date and software version

Published 8 July 2013. Based on LibreOffice 4.0.

Documentation for LibreOffice is available at http://www.libreoffice.org/get-help/documentation

Contents

Copyright..................................................................................................................................... 2

Preface.................................................................................................................................. 7

Who is this book for?................................................................................................................... 8

What's in this book?..................................................................................................................... 8

Where to get more help............................................................................................................... 8

What you see may be different.................................................................................................... 9

Using LibreOffice on a Mac........................................................................................................ 10

What are all these things called?............................................................................................... 10

Who wrote this book?................................................................................................................. 11

Acknowledgements.................................................................................................................... 11

Frequently asked questions....................................................................................................... 12

Chapter 1

Introducing Impress...........................................................................................................13

What is Impress?....................................................................................................................... 14

Starting Impress......................................................................................................................... 14

Main Impress window................................................................................................................ 15

Workspace views....................................................................................................................... 18

Creating a new presentation...................................................................................................... 22

Formatting a presentation.......................................................................................................... 25

Running a slide show................................................................................................................. 30

Using the Presenter Console..................................................................................................... 31

Chapter 2

Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates................................................................... 33

Designing a presentation........................................................................................................... 34

What are slide masters?............................................................................................................ 34

Working with slide masters........................................................................................................ 35

Working with styles in Impress................................................................................................... 45

Working with templates.............................................................................................................. 45

Chapter 3

Adding and Formatting Text............................................................................................. 53

Introduction................................................................................................................................ 54

Working with text boxes............................................................................................................. 54

Inserting text.............................................................................................................................. 58

Formatting text........................................................................................................................... 60

Formatting characters................................................................................................................ 63

Formatting paragraphs............................................................................................................... 65

Creating bulleted and numbered lists......................................................................................... 69

Using tables............................................................................................................................... 74

Using fields................................................................................................................................ 80

Using hyperlinks........................................................................................................................ 81

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide 3

Chapter 4

Adding and Formatting Pictures...................................................................................... 85

Introduction................................................................................................................................ 86

Inserting pictures....................................................................................................................... 86

Managing Gallery themes.......................................................................................................... 89

Formatting pictures.................................................................................................................... 92

Creating an image map............................................................................................................ 100

Chapter 5

Managing Graphic Objects............................................................................................. 103

Introduction.............................................................................................................................. 104

Drawing toolbar........................................................................................................................ 104

Creating lines and shapes....................................................................................................... 108

Grouping objects together........................................................................................................ 111

Moving graphic objects............................................................................................................ 112

Resizing graphic objects.......................................................................................................... 113

Applying special effects............................................................................................................ 114

Aligning objects........................................................................................................................ 118

Snapping objects to grid or snap guides.................................................................................. 119

Arranging objects..................................................................................................................... 120

Working with connectors.......................................................................................................... 121

Working with 3D objects.......................................................................................................... 123

Converting objects to different types........................................................................................ 124

Setting up interaction with an object........................................................................................ 125

Using Fontwork........................................................................................................................ 126

Animations............................................................................................................................... 128

Chapter 6

Formatting Graphic Objects........................................................................................... 135

Formatting objects................................................................................................................... 136

Formatting lines....................................................................................................................... 136

Formatting area fills................................................................................................................. 141

Creating new area fills............................................................................................................. 144

Formatting text in objects......................................................................................................... 153

Formatting connectors............................................................................................................. 155

Working with graphics styles.................................................................................................... 156

Chapter 7

Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects...................................................161

OLE objects............................................................................................................................. 162

Spreadsheets........................................................................................................................... 164

Charts...................................................................................................................................... 170

Movies and sound.................................................................................................................... 176

Formulas.................................................................................................................................. 178

Drawings, text files, HTML files and other objects.................................................................... 178

4 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Chapter 8

Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts.................................................179

Introduction.............................................................................................................................. 180

Adding, renaming, and removing slides................................................................................... 180

Creating slides from an outline.................................................................................................184

Modifying slides....................................................................................................................... 186

Comments............................................................................................................................... 189

Presentation notes................................................................................................................... 191

Presentation handouts............................................................................................................. 196

Chapter 9

Slide Shows...................................................................................................................... 199

Creating a slide show............................................................................................................... 200

Using slide transitions.............................................................................................................. 204

Using animation effects............................................................................................................ 207

Using interactions.................................................................................................................... 213

Slide shows.............................................................................................................................. 214

Chapter 10

Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows............................................217

Introduction.............................................................................................................................. 218

Quick printing........................................................................................................................... 218

Controlling printing................................................................................................................... 218

Brochure printing..................................................................................................................... 221

PDF export............................................................................................................................... 222

Flash file export....................................................................................................................... 228

Web pages (HTML files) export................................................................................................229

E-mailing a presentation.......................................................................................................... 231

Digital signing of documents.................................................................................................... 232

Removing personal data.......................................................................................................... 233

Opening and saving a PowerPoint file..................................................................................... 233

Chapter 11

Setting Up and Customizing Impress............................................................................ 235

LibreOffice options................................................................................................................... 236

Choosing options for Impress.................................................................................................. 239

Customizing the user interface.................................................................................................243

Adding functions with extensions............................................................................................. 251

Appendix A

Keyboard Shortcuts.........................................................................................................253

Introduction.............................................................................................................................. 254

Impress function keys.............................................................................................................. 254

Slide show shortcut keys......................................................................................................... 255

Normal view shortcut keys....................................................................................................... 256

Editing text shortcut keys......................................................................................................... 256

Impress shortcut keys.............................................................................................................. 257

Slide Sorter navigation............................................................................................................. 258

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide 5

Using shortcut keys..................................................................................................................258

Index.................................................................................................................................. 261

6 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Preface

8

Who is this book for?

Anyone who wants to get up to speed quickly with LibreOffice Impress will find this book valuable.

You may be new to presentation software, or you may be familiar with another program such as

Microsoft PowerPoint.

What's in this book?

This book covers the main features of Impress, the presentations (slide show) component of

LibreOffice. Using Impress, you can create slides that contain text, bulleted and numbered lists, tables, charts, clip art, and other objects.

Impress comes with prepackaged text styles, slide backgrounds, and Help. It can open and save to

Microsoft PowerPoint formats and can export to PDF, HTML, Adobe Flash, and numerous graphic formats.

Where to get more help

This book, the other LibreOffice user guides, the built-in Help system, and user support systems assume that you are familiar with your computer and basic functions such as starting a program, opening and saving files.

Help system

LibreOffice comes with an extensive Help system. This is your first line of support for using

LibreOffice.

To display the full Help system, press F1 or select LibreOffice Help from the Help menu. In addition, you can choose whether to activate Tips, Extended tips, and the Help Agent (using Tools

> Options > LibreOffice > General).

If Tips are enabled, place the mouse pointer over any of the icons to see a small box (“tooltip”) with a brief explanation of the icon’s function. For a more detailed explanation, select Help > What's

This? and hold the pointer over the icon.

Free online support

The LibreOffice community not only develops software, but provides free, volunteer-based support.

See Table 1 and this web page:

http://www.libreoffice.org/get-help/

Users can get comprehensive online support from the community through mailing lists and the Ask

LibreOffice website, http://ask.libreoffice.org/en/questions/ . Other websites run by users also offer free tips and tutorials. This forum provides community support for LibreOffice: http://en.libreofficeforum.org/ .

This site provides support for LibreOffice and other programs: http://user.services.openoffice.org/en/forum/ .

Paid support and training

Alternatively, you can pay for support services

.

Service contracts can be purchased from a vendor or consulting firm specializing in LibreOffice

.

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Table 1: Free support for LibreOffice users

Free LibreOffice support

Ask LibreOffice

Questions and answers from the LibreOffice community http://ask.libreoffice.org/en/questions/

Documentation

User guides, how-tos, and other documentation. http://www.libreoffice.org/get-help/documentation/ https://wiki.documentfoundation.org/Documentation/Publications

FAQs

Mailing lists

International support

Accessibility options

Answers to frequently asked questions http://wiki.documentfoundation.org/Faq

Free community support is provided by a network of experienced users http://www.libreoffice.org/get-help/mailing-lists/

The LibreOffice website in your language.

http://www.libreoffice.org/international-sites/

International mailing lists http://wiki.documentfoundation.org/Local_Mailing_Lists

Information about available accessibility options. http://www.libreoffice.org/get-help/accessibility/

What you see may be different

Illustrations

LibreOffice runs on Windows, Linux, and Mac OS X operating systems, each of which has several versions and can be customized by users (fonts, colors, themes, window managers). The illustrations in this guide were taken from a variety of computers and operating systems. Therefore, some illustrations will not look exactly like what you see on your computer display.

Also, some of the dialogs may be differ because of the settings selected in LibreOffice. You can either use dialogs from your computer system (default) or dialogs provided by LibreOffice. To change to using LibreOffice dialogs:

1) On Linux and Windows operating systems, go to Tools > Options >LibreOffice > General on the main menu bar to open the dialog for general options.

2) On a Mac operating system, go to LibreOffice > Preferences > General on the main menu bar to open the dialog for general options.

3) Select Use LibreOffice dialogs in Open/Save dialogs and, in Linux and Mac OS X operating systems only, Print dialogs to display the LibreOffice dialogs on your computer display.

4) Click OK to save your settings and close the dialog.

Icons

The icons used to illustrate some of the many tools available in LibreOffice may differ from the ones used in this guide. The icons in this guide have been taken from a LibreOffice installation that has been set to display the Galaxy set of icons.

If you wish, you can change your LibreOffice software package to display Galaxy icons as follows:

1) On Linux and Windows operating systems, go to Tools > Options >LibreOffice > View on the main menu bar to open the dialog for view options.

Preface 9

2) On a Mac operating system, go to LibreOffice > Preferences > View on the main menu bar to open the dialog for view options.

3) In User interface > Icon size and style select Galaxy from the options available in the dropdown list.

4) Click OK to save your settings and close the dialog.

Note

Some Linux operating systems, for example Ubuntu, include LibreOffice as part of the installation and may not include the Galaxy set of icons. You should be able to download the Galaxy icon set from the software repository for your Linux operating system.

Using LibreOffice on a Mac

Some keystrokes and menu items are different on a Mac from those used in Windows and Linux.

The table below gives some common substitutions for the instructions in this chapter. For a more detailed list, see the application Help.

Windows or Linux

Tools > Options menu selection

Right-click

Ctrl (Control)

F5

F11

Mac equivalent

LibreOffice > Preferences

Control+click and/or right-

click depending on computer setup z (Command)

Shift+z+F5 z +T

Effect

Access setup options

Open a context menu

Used with other keys

Open the Navigator

Open the Styles and Formatting window

What are all these things called?

The terms used in LibreOffice for most parts of the user interface (the parts of the program you see and use, in contrast to the behind-the-scenes code that actually makes it work) are the same as for most other programs.

A dialog is a special type of window. Its purpose is to inform you of something, or request input from you, or both. It provides controls for you to use to specify how to carry out an action. The

technical names for common controls are shown in Figure 1. In most cases we do not use the

technical terms in this book, but it is useful to know them because the Help and other sources of information often use them.

1) Tabbed page (not strictly speaking a control).

2) Radio buttons (only one can be selected at a time).

3) Checkbox (more than one can be selected at a time).

4) Spin box (click the up and down arrows to change the number shown in the text box next to it, or type in the text box).

5) Thumbnail or preview.

6) Drop-down list from which to select an item.

7) Push buttons.

10 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 1: Dialog showing common controls

In most cases, you can interact only with the dialog (not the document itself) as long as the dialog remains open. When you close the dialog after use (usually, clicking OK or another button saves your changes and closes the dialog), then you can again work with your document.

Some dialogs can be left open as you work, so you can switch back and forth between the dialog and your document. An example of this type is the Find & Replace dialog.

Who wrote this book?

This book was written by volunteers from the LibreOffice community. Profits from sales of the printed edition will be used to benefit the community.

Acknowledgements

This book is adapted and updated from OpenOffice.org 3.3 Impress Guide. The contributors to that book are:

Michele Zarri

Agnes Belzunce

Claire Wood

Jared Kobos

Nicole Cairns

Jean Hollis Weber

Peter Hillier-Brook

Rachel Kartch

Martin J Fox

Rachel Kartch

Dan Lewis

Gary Schnabl

Hazel Russman

Paul Miller

Preface 11

Frequently asked questions

How is LibreOffice licensed?

LibreOffice is distributed under the Open Source Initiative (OSI) approved Lesser General

Public License (LGPL). The LGPL license is available from the LibreOffice website: http://www.libreoffice.org/download/license/

May I distribute LibreOffice to anyone?

Yes.

How many computers may I install it on?

As many as you like.

May I sell it?

Yes.

May I use LibreOffice in my business?

Yes.

May I distribute the PDF of this book, or print and sell copies?

Yes, as long as you meet the requirements of one of the licenses in the copyright statement at the beginning of this book. You do not have to request special permission. In addition, we request that you share with the project some of the profits you make from sales of books, in consideration of all the work we have put into producing them.

How can I contribute to LibreOffice?

You can help with the development and user support of LibreOffice in many ways, and you do not need to be a programmer. For example, you can help with producing and maintaining written user documentation, producing video tutorials, and other user support services. To start, check out this webpage: http://www.documentfoundation.org/contribution/

12 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Chapter

1

Introducing Impress

What is Impress?

Impress is the presentation (slide show) program included in LibreOffice. You can create slides that contain many different elements, including text, bulleted and numbered lists, tables, charts, and a wide range of graphic objects such as clipart, drawings and photographs. Impress also includes a spelling checker, a thesaurus, text styles, and background styles.

This chapter introduces the Impress user interface and describes how to create a simple slide show using the Presentation Wizard. The other chapters in this guide explain all the features available in Impress that can be used to create more sophisticated slide shows.

To use Impress for more than very simple slide shows requires some knowledge of the elements which the slides contain. Slides containing text use styles to determine the appearance of that text.

Creating drawings in Impress is similar to using the Draw program included in LibreOffice. See the

Draw Guide for more details on how to use the drawing tools.

Starting Impress

You can start Impress in several ways:

From the LibreOffice Start Center, if no component is open: click on the Presentation icon.

From the system menu, the standard menu from which most applications are started. On

Windows, it is called the Start menu. On Linux with a Gnome desktop, it is called the

Applications menu; on a KDE desktop, it is identified by the KDE logo. On Mac OS X, it is the Applications menu. Details vary with your operating system; see the Getting Started

Guide Chapter 1 Introducing LibreOffice.

On Windows, use the Presentation selection in the LibreOffice Quickstarter. Similar functions exist for Mac OS X and Linux; see the Getting Started Guide Chapter 1

Introducing LibreOffice.

From any open component of LibreOffice. Click the triangle to the right of the New icon on the main menu bar and select Presentation from the drop-down menu or choose File >

New > Presentation on the main menu bar.

Note

When LibreOffice was installed on your computer, in most cases a menu entry for each component was added to your system menu. The exact name and location of these menu entries depend on the operating system and graphical user interface.

When you start Impress for the first time, the Presentation Wizard is shown. Here you can choose from the following options:

Empty presentation, which gives you a blank document

From template, which is a presentation designed with a template of your choice

Open existing presentation

Click Create to open the main Impress window.

For detailed instructions about how to use the Presentation Wizard, see “Creating a new presentation” on page 22.

If you prefer not to use the Presentation Wizard, select the Do not show this wizard again option before clicking Create.

You can enable the wizard again later under Tools > Options > LibreOffice

Impress > General > New document on the main menu bar and select the Start with wizard option.

14 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Main Impress window

The main Impress window (Figure 2) has three parts: the Slides pane, the Workspace, and the

Tasks pane. Additionally, several toolbars can be displayed or hidden during the creation of a presentation.

Figure 2: Main window of Impress; ovals indicate the Hide/Show markers

Tip

You can close the Slides pane or the Tasks pane by clicking the X in the upper right corner of the pane or by choosing View

Pane again.

>

Slide Pane or View

>

Tasks Pane to deselect the pane. To reopen a pane, choose View

>

Slide Pane or View

> Tasks

You can also maximize the Workspace area by clicking on the Hide/Show marker in

the middle of the vertical separator line (indicated by ovals in Figure 2). Using the

Hide/Show marker hides, but does not close, the Slides and Tasks panes. To restore the pane, click again on its Hide/Show marker.

Slides pane

The Slides pane contains thumbnail pictures of the slides in your presentation, in the order the slides will be shown, unless you change the slide show order that is described in Chapter 9 Slide

Shows. Clicking a slide in this pane selects it and places it in the Workspace. When a slide is in the

Workspace, you can make any changes you like.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 15

Several additional operations can be performed on one or more slides simultaneously in the Slides pane:

Add new slides to the presentation.

Mark a slide as hidden so that it will not be shown as part of the presentation.

Delete a slide from the presentation if it is no longer needed.

Rename a slide.

Duplicate a slide (copy and paste) or move it to a different position in the presentation (cut and paste).

It is also possible to perform the following operations, although there are more efficient methods than using the Slides pane, as you will see later in this chapter:

Change the slide transition following the selected slide or after each slide in a group of slides.

Change the sequence of slides in the presentation.

Change the slide design.

Change slide layout for a group of slides simultaneously.

Tasks pane

The Tasks pane has five sections. To expand the section you wish to use, click on the title bar of each section. Only one section at a time can be expanded.

Master Pages

Here you define the page (slide) style for your presentation. Impress includes several designs of Master Pages (slide masters). One of them, Default, is blank, and the rest have background and styled text.

Tip

Press F11 to open the Styles and Formatting window, where you can modify the styles used in any master page to suit your purposes. This can be done at any time.

See Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates for more information.

Layouts

The layouts included in Impress are shown here. You can choose the one you want and use it as it is, or you can modify it to meet your own requirements. However, it is not possible to save custom layouts.

Table Design

The standard table styles are provided in this section. You can further modify the appearance of a table with the options to show or hide specific rows and columns, or to apply a banded appearance to the rows and columns. Refer to Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text for details on how to work with tables.

Custom Animation

A variety of animations can be used to emphasize or enhance different elements of each slide.

The Custom Animation section provides an easy way to add, change, or remove animations.

See Chapter 9 Slide Shows for an overview of how to add and customize animations.

Slide Transition

The Slide Transition section provides access to a number of slide transition options. The default is set to No Transition, in which the following slide simply replaces the existing one. However, many additional transitions are available. You can also specify the transition speed (slow, medium, fast), choose between an automatic or manual transition, and choose how long the selected slide should be shown (automatic transition only).

16 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Workspace

The Workspace (normally in the center) has five tabs: Normal, Outline, Notes, Handout, and

Slide Sorter (Figure 3). These five tabs are called View buttons. The Workspace below the View

buttons changes depending on the chosen view. The workspace views are described in detail on

page 18.

Figure 3: Workspace tabs

Toolbars

Many toolbars can be used during slide creation; they can be displayed or hidden by going to View

> Toolbars on the main menu bar and selecting from the context menu.

You can also select the icons that you wish to appear on each toolbar. For more information, refer to Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress.

Many of the toolbars in Impress are similar to the toolbars in Draw. Refer to the Draw Guide for details on the functions available and how to use them.

Status bar

The status bar, located at the bottom of the Impress window, contains information that you may find useful when working on a presentation. You can hide the Status Bar by going to View on the main menu bar and deselecting Status Bar in the context menu.

Note

The sizes are given in the current measurement unit (not to be confused with the ruler units). This unit is defined in Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress >

General.

Figure 4: Status bar

From left to right, you will find:

Information area – changes depending on the selection. For example:

Example selection

Text area

Charts, spreadsheets

Graphics

Examples of information shown

Text Edit: Paragraph x, Row y, Column z

Embedded object (OLE) “ObjectName” selected

Bitmap with transparency selected

Cursor position – the position of the cursor or of the top left corner of the selection measured from the top left corner of the slide, followed by the width and height of the selection or text box where the cursor is located.

Unsaved changes – a flag indicating that the file needs saving. Double clicking on this flag opens the file save dialog.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 17

Digital signature – a flag indicating whether the document is digitally signed. After the file has been saved, double clicking on this flag opens the digital signatures dialog.

Slide number – the slide number currently displayed in the Workspace and the total number of slides in the presentation.

Page (slide) style – the style associated with the slide, handout, or notes page currently in the Workspace. Double clicking on the style name opens the slide design dialog.

Zoom slider – adjusts the zoom percentage of the Workspace displayed.

Zoom percentage – indicates the zoom percentage of the Workspace displayed. Double clicking on zoom percentage opens the zoom and layout dialog.

Navigator

The Navigator displays all objects contained in a document. It provides another convenient way to move around a document and find items in it. To open the Navigator dialog, click the Navigator icon on the Standard toolbar, or go to View > Navigator on the main menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+Shift+F5.

The Navigator is more useful if you give your slides and objects (pictures, spreadsheets, and so on) meaningful names, instead of leaving them with default names, for example “Slide 1” and

“Shape 1”.

Figure 5: Navigator dialog

Workspace views

Each of the Workspace views is designed to ease the completion of certain tasks; it is therefore useful to familiarize yourself with them to quickly accomplish those tasks.

Note

Each Workspace view displays a different set of toolbars when selected. These toolbar sets can be customized by going to View > Toolbars, then check or uncheck the toolbar you want to add or remove.

18 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Normal view

Normal view is the main view for creating individual slides. Use this view to format and design slides and to add text, graphics, and animation effects.

To place a slide in the slide design area of the Normal view (Figure 2 on page 15), either click the

slide thumbnail in the Slides pane or double-click it in the Navigator (page 18).

Outline view

Outline view (Figure 6) contains all of the slides of the presentation in their numbered sequence. It

shows topic titles, bulleted lists, and numbered lists for each slide in outline format. Only the text contained in the default text boxes in each slide is shown. If you have added text boxes or graphic objects to the slides, then these objects are not displayed. Slide names are not included.

Figure 6: Outline view

Figure 7: Outline level and movement arrows in Text Formatting toolbar

Use Outline view for:

1) Making changes in the text of a slide: a) Add or delete text in a slide just as in the Normal view.

b) Move the paragraphs of text in the selected slide up or down by using the up and down

arrow buttons (Move Up or Move Down) on the Text Formatting toolbar (highlighted in

Figure 7).

c) Change the outline level for any of the paragraphs in a slide using the left and right arrow buttons (Promote or Demote) on the Text Formatting toolbar.

d) Simultaneously move a paragraph and change its outline level using a combination of these four arrow buttons.

2) Comparing the slides with your outline (if you have prepared one in advance). If you notice from your outline that another slide is needed, you can create it directly in the Outline view, or you can return to the Normal view to create it.

Notes view

Use the Notes view (Figure 8) to add notes to a slide. These notes are not seen when the

presentation is shown to an audience on an extra display monitor connected to your computer.

1) Click the Notes tab in the Workspace.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 19

Figure 8: Adding notes in Notes view

2) Select the slide to which you want to add notes.

3) Click the slide in the Slide pane, or double-click the slide name in the Navigator.

4) In the text box below the slide, click on the words Click to add notes and begin typing.

You can resize the Notes text box using the resizing handles which appear when you click on the edge of the box. You can also move the box by placing the pointer on the border, then clicking and dragging. To make changes in the text style, press the F11 key to open the Styles and Formatting dialog.

Handout view

Handout view is for setting up the layout of your slide for a printed handout. Click the Handout tab

in the Workspace, then select Layouts in the Tasks pane (Figure 9). You can then choose to print

1, 2, 3, 4, 6, or 9 slides per page.

You can also use this view to customize the information printed on the handout. Refer to Chapter 8

Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts for more information.

Select from the main menu Insert > Page Number or Insert > Date and Time and the Header

and Footer dialog opens. Click on the Notes and Handouts tab (Figure 10) and use this dialog to

select the elements you want to appear on each handout page and their contents.

20

Figure 9: Handout layouts

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 10: Header and Footer dialog – Notes and Handouts page

Slide Sorter view

The Slide Sorter view (Figure 11) contains all of the slide thumbnails. Use this view to work with a

group of slides or with only one slide.

Figure 11: Slide Sorter view

Customizing Slide Sorter view

To change the number of slides per row:

1) Check View > Toolbars > Slide Sorter and Slide View to show or hide the slide sorter and

view toolbars (Figure 12).

2) Adjust the number of slides (up to a maximum of 15).

Figure 12: Slide Sorter and Slide View toolbars

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 21

Moving a slide using Slide Sorter

To move a slide in a presentation using the Slide Sorter:

1) Click the slide to highlight it (Figure 11).

2) Drag and drop it to the location you want.

Selecting and moving groups of slides

To select a group of slides, use one of these methods:

Using the Ctrl key – click on the first slide and, while pressing the Ctrl key, select the other desired slides.

Using the Shift key – click on the first slide, and while pressing the Shift key, select the final slide in the group. This selects all of the other slides between the first and the last slide selected.

Using the mouse – click slightly to one side (left or right) of the first slide to be selected.

Hold down the left mouse button and drag the cursor until all of the slides you want selected are highlighted.

To move a group of slides:

1) Select a group of slides.

2) Drag and drop the group to their new location.

Working in Slide Sorter view

You can work with slides in the Slide Sorter view just as you can in the Slide pane. To make changes, right-click a slide and choose any of the following from the context menu:

New Slide – adds a new slide after the selected slide.

Duplicate Slide – creates a duplicate of the selected slide and places the new slide immediately after the selected slide.

Delete Slide – deletes the selected slide.

Rename Slide – allows you to rename the selected slide.

Slide Layout – allows you to change the layout of the selected slide.

Slide Transition – allows you to change the transition of the selected slide.

For one slide, select a slide and add the desired transition.

For more than one slide, select a group of slides and add the desired transition.

Hide Slide – any slides that are hidden are not shown in the slide show.

Cut – removes the selected slide and saves it to the clipboard.

Copy – copies the selected slide to the clipboard without removing it.

Paste – inserts a slide from the clipboard after the selected slide.

Creating a new presentation

This section shows you how to create a new presentation using the Presentation Wizard.

Tip

The first thing to do is decide on the purpose of the presentation and plan the presentation. Although you can make changes as you go, having an idea of who the audience will be, the structure, the content, and how the presentation will be delivered, will save you a lot of time from the start.

22 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

When you start Impress, the Presentation Wizard (Figure 13) appears.

1) Under Type, choose one of the options:

Empty presentation creates a blank presentation.

From template uses a template design already created as the basis for a new presentation. The wizard changes to show a list of available templates. Choose the template you want. More details can be found in Chapter 2, Using Slide Masters,

Styles, and Templates.

Open existing presentation continues work on a previously created presentation. The wizard changes to show a list of existing presentations. Choose the one you want.

Figure 13: Choosing the type of presentation

2) Click Next and the Presentation Wizard step 2 opens. It appears as shown in Figure 14 if

you selected Empty presentation at step 1. If you selected From template, an example slide is shown in the Preview box.

3) Choose a design under Select a slide design. The slide design section gives Presentation

Backgrounds with a list of choices for slide designs. If you want to use one of these other than <Original>, click it to select it.

4) Select how the presentation will be used under Select an output medium. Most often, presentations are created for computer screen display, so you would select Screen. You can change the page format at any time.

Note

The default Screen page is for a 4:3 display (28cm x 21cm) which is not suitable for modern wide-screen displays. You can change the slide size at any time by switching to Normal view and selecting Format > Page.

5) Click Next and the Presentation Wizard step 3 (Figure 15) opens.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 23

Figure 14: Selecting a slide design

24

Figure 15: Selecting a slide transition effect

6) Select the desired slide transition from the Effect drop-down menu.

7) Select the desired speed for the transition between the different slides in the presentation from the Speed drop-down menu. Medium is a good choice for now.

8) Select the presentation type – Default or Automatic.

a) Choosing Default displays the presentation as a full screen presentation with the specified speed you selected from the Speed drop down list.

b) Choosing Automatic will allow you to set the duration the slide is displayed and the duration of the pause between the end and restart of the presentation.

9) Click Create and your new presentation is created.

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Tip

Note

You can accept the default values for both Effect and Speed unless you are skilled at creating presentations. Both of these values can be changed later while working with Slide transitions and animations. These two features are explained in more detail in Chapter 9 Slide Shows.

If you selected From template on step 1 of the Wizard, the Next button will be active on step 3 and other pages will be available. These pages are not described here.

Caution

Remember to save frequently while working on the presentation, to prevent any loss of information should something unexpected occur. You might also want to activate the AutoRecovery function (Tools > Options > Load/Save > General).

Make sure Save AutoRecovery information every is selected and that you have entered a recovery frequency.

Formatting a presentation

A new presentation only contains one empty slide. In this section we will start adding new slides and preparing them for the intended contents.

Inserting slides

New slide

A new slide can be inserted into a presentation as follows:

1) Go to Insert on the main menu bar and select Slide.

2) Or right-click on a slide in the Workspace, Slides Pane or Slide Sorter view and select

Slide > New Slide from the context menu.

3) Or click the Slide icon

in the Presentation toolbar. If the Presentation toolbar (Figure

16) is not visible, go to View > Toolbars on the main menu bar and select Presentation

from the list.

4) A new slide is inserted after the selected slide in the presentation.

Figure 16: Presentation toolbar

Duplicate slide

Sometimes, rather than starting from a new slide you may want to duplicate a slide already included in your presentation. To duplicate a slide:

1) Select the slide you want to duplicate from the Slides Pane.

2) Right click on the slide in the Slides Pane or Workspace and select Duplicate Slide from the context menu.

3) Or, go to Slide Sorter view, right click on a slide and select Duplicate Slide from the context menu.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 25

4) Alternatively, go to Insert on the main menu bar and select Duplicate Slide.

5) A duplicate slide is inserted after the selected slide in the presentation.

Figure 17: Available slide layouts

Selecting a slide layout

In the Tasks pane, select the Layout drawer to display the available layouts (Figure 17). The

Layouts differ in the number of elements a slide will contain, from a blank slide to a slide with six contents boxes and a title.

The first slide in a presentation is normally a title slide. The Title Slide (which also contains a section for a subtitle) or Title Only are suitable layouts for the first slide, while for most of the remaining slides you will probably use the Title, Contents layout.

Selecting layout

Assuming that the Blank Slide layout was not selected:

1) Click on Click to add title and then type the title text. To adjust the formatting of the title, modify the Title presentation style; see Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and

Templates for instructions.

2) If you are using the Title Slide layout, click on Click to add text to add a subtitle. To adjust the formatting of the subtitle, modify the Subtitle presentation style; see Chapter 2 Using

Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates for instructions.

Note

Text and graphic elements can be readjusted at any time during the preparation of the presentation, but changing the layout of a slide that already contains some contents can have a dramatic effect. It is therefore recommended that you pay particular attention to the layout you select. If you do need to change the layout after contents have been added, the contents are not lost though they may need to be reformatted.

Tip

To view the names for the included layouts, use the Tooltip feature: position the cursor on an icon in the Layout section (or on any toolbar icon) and its name will be displayed in a small rectangle.

26 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 18: Selecting contents type

Changing layout

To select or change the layout:

1) Place the slide in the work area and select the desired layout from the layout drawer in the

Task Pane. Several layouts contain one or more content boxes. Each of these boxes can be configured to contain one of the following elements: Text, Movie, Picture, Chart or Table.

2) Select the type of contents by clicking on the icon that is displayed in the middle of the

contents box as shown in Figure 18.

3) If instead you intend to use the contents box for text, just click on the Click to add text and type your text.

Note

If you have selected a layout with one or more contents boxes, this is a good time to decide what type of contents you want to insert.

Modifying slide elements

A slide contains elements that were included in the slide master, as well those elements included in the selected slide layout. However, it is unlikely that the predefined layouts will suit all your needs for your presentation. You may want to remove elements that are not required or insert objects such as text and graphics.

Although Impress does not have the functionality to create new layouts, it allows you to resize and move the layout elements. It is also possible to add slide elements without being limited to the size and position of the layout boxes.

To resize a contents box, click on the outer frame so that the 8 resizing handles are displayed. To move it place the mouse cursor on the frame so that the cursor changes shape. You can now click the left mouse button and drag the contents box to its new position on the slide.

To remove any unwanted elements, do this:

1) Click the element to highlight it. The resizing handles show it is highlighted.

2) Press the Delete key to remove it.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 27

Caution

Changes to any of the layouts included in Impress can only be made using View

>

Normal, which is the default. Attempting any changes by modifying a slide master, although possible, may result in unpredictable results and requires extra care as well as a certain amount of trial and error.

Adding text

To add text to a slide that contains a text frame, click on Click to add text in the text frame and then type your text. The Outline styles are automatically applied to the text as you insert it. You can change the outline level of each paragraph as well as its position within the text by using the arrow

buttons on the Text Formatting toolbar (see Figure 6 and “Outline view” on page 19). For more

information on text, see Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text.

Adding objects

To add any pictures or objects to a slide, for example a picture, clipart, drawing, photograph, or spreadsheet, click on Insert then select from the drop down menu what type of insert you require.

For more information, see the following chapters:

For pictures, see Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures.

For graphic objects, see Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects and Chapter 6 Formatting

Graphic Objects.

For OLE and other objects, see Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other

Objects.

Modifying slide appearance

To change the background and other characteristics of all slides in the presentation, you need to modify the master page or choose a different master page.

A Slide Master is a slide with a specified set of characteristics that acts as a template and is used as the starting point for creating other slides. These characteristics include the background, objects in the background, formatting of any text used, and any background graphics.

Note

LibreOffice uses three interchangeable terms for this one concept. Master slide,

slide master, and master page. These terms all refer to a slide that is used to create other slides. This user guide, however, uses only the term slide master, except when describing the user interface.

Impress has included a range of slide masters, found in the Master Pages section of the Tasks pane. You can also create and save additional slide masters or add more from other sources. See

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates for information on creating and modifying slide masters.

If all you need to do is to change the background, you can use a shortcut:

1) Select Format > Page and go to the Background tab on the Page Setup dialog that opens.

2) Select the desired background between solid color, gradient, hatching and bitmap.

3) Click OK to apply it.

A dialog box opens, asking if the background should be applied to all the slides. If you click Yes,

Impress automatically modifies the master page for you.

28 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Note

Inserting and correctly formatting a background is beyond the scope of this chapter, but you can find all the information you need in the Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic

Objects and the Draw Guide Chapter 4 Changing Object Attributes.

Modifying a slide show

By default the slide show will display all the slides in the same order as they appear in the slide sorter, using any transition between slides specified in the Presentation Wizard, and you need some keyboard or mouse interaction to move from one slide to the next.

Now is a good time to review the entire presentation and answer some questions. Run the slide

show at least once (see “Running a slide show” on page 30) before answering them. You might

want to add some questions of your own.

1) Are the slides in the correct order? If not, some of them will need to be moved.

2) Is the information well spaced and visible to members of an audience at the back of a large room? They may not be able to see information at the bottom of a slide, so you may need to design your presentation to fit the top three-quarters of the screen.

3) Would an additional slide make a particular point clearer? If so, another slide needs to be created.

4) Do some of the slides seem unnecessary? Hide or delete them.

5) Would custom animations help some of the slides? (Advanced technique.)

6) Should some of the slides have a different slide transition than others? The transition of those slides should be changed.

Tip

If one or more slides seem to be unnecessary, hide the slide or slides, and view the slide show a few more times to make sure they are not needed. To hide a slide, right-click the slide in the Slides pane and select Hide Slide from the context menu.

Do not delete a slide until you have done this; otherwise you may have to create that slide again.

Once you have answered these and your own questions, make the necessary changes. This is

done most easily in the Slide Sorter view (see “Slide Sorter view” on page 21). Use the Slide Show

menu to change the order of the slides, choose which ones are shown, automate moving from one slide to the next, and other settings. To change the slide transition, animate slides, and make other enhancements, use the various selections in the Task pane.

Custom animations

If you wish to add a custom animation to a slide, do it now. Custom animations are found in the

Custom Animation section of the Tasks pane. This is an advanced technique and is explained in

Chapter 9 Slide Shows.

Slide transitions

Your first slide show will probably have the same slide transition for all slides. Setting Advance

slide to On mouse click is the default. If you want each slide to be shown for a specific amount of time, click Automatically after and enter the number of seconds. Click Apply to all slides.

Transition choices are found under Slide Transition on the Tasks pane. For more information about slide transitions see Chapter 9 Slide Shows.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 29

Tip

The Slide Transition section has a very useful option: Automatic preview. With this option selected, when you make any changes in a slide transition, the new slide is previewed in the Slide Design area, including its transition effect.

Running a slide show

1) To run the slide show, do one of the following:

Click Slide Show > Slide Show on the main menu bar.

Click the Slide Show icon on the Presentation toolbar or the Slide Sorter toolbar.

Press F5 or F9. (F9 does not work on a Mac.)

2) If the slide transition is Automatically after x seconds, let the slide show run by itself.

3) If the slide transition is On mouse click, do one of the following to move from one slide to the next.

Click the mouse button to advance to the next slide.

Use the arrow keys on the keyboard to go to the next slide or to go back to the previous one.

Press the Spacebar on the keyboard to advance to the next slide.

4) Right-click anywhere on the screen to open a menu from which you can navigate the slides and set other options.

5) When you advance past the last slide, the message Click to exit presentation... appears.

Click the mouse or press any key to exit the presentation.

6) To exit the slide show at any time including at the end, press the Esc key.

30

Figure 19: Impress Presenter Console

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Using the Presenter Console

LibreOffice Impress has a Presenter Console function that can be used when an extra display for

presentation has been connected your computer. The Presenter Console (Figure 19) provides

extra control over slide shows by using different views on your computer display and on the display that the audience sees. The view you see on your computer display includes the current slide, the upcoming slide, any slide notes, and a presentation timer.

For more information and details about using the Presenter Console, see the Chapter 9 Slide

Shows.

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress 31

Chapter

2

Using Slide Masters,

Styles, and Templates

Designing a presentation

In addition to careful planning of the content, as discussed in Chapter 1 Introducing Impress, you need to plan the appearance of the presentation. It is best to do this after you have developed an outline, because the outline will determine some of the requirements for the appearance of the slides. For example:

What color combinations (background and text) will look good and also be easy for your audience to read?

Would a picture help your audience understand the contents better?

Do you want particular text and a picture to appear on all the slides? For example a company name and logo.

Would the audience benefit from having the slides numbered so that they can quickly refer to one of them?

Do you want a background graphic or gradient? If so, you need to pick something that does not interfere or clash with content such as the colors used in charts.

Will you need one slide master or more than one? Will one slide design suit all of the content?

You can change the appearance of slides as you develop the presentation, but planning ahead will save you time in the long run.

What are slide masters?

A slide master is a slide that is used as the starting point for other slides. It is similar to a page style in Writer: it controls the basic formatting of all slides based on it. A slide show can have more than one slide master.

Note

LibreOffice uses three terms for one concept: slide master, master slide, and master

page. All refer to a slide which is used to create other slides. This book uses the term

slide master, except when describing the user interface.

A slide master has a defined set of characteristics, including the background color, graphic, or gradient; objects (such as logos, decorative lines, and other graphics) in the background; headers and footers; placement and size of text frames; and the formatting of text.

All of the characteristics of slide masters are controlled by styles. The styles of any new slide you create are inherited from the slide master from which it was created. In other words, the styles of the slide master are available and applied to all slides created from that slide master. Changing a style in a slide master results in changes to all the slides based on that slide master. It is, however, possible to modify each individual slide without affecting the slide master.

Note

Although it is highly recommended to use the slide masters whenever possible, there are occasions where manual changes are needed for a particular slide, for example to enlarge the chart area when the text and chart layout is used.

Slide masters have two types of styles associated with them: presentation styles and graphic

styles. The prepackaged presentation styles can be modified, but new presentation styles cannot be created. For graphic styles, you can modify the prepackaged styles and also create new styles.

Presentation styles are discussed in detail in Chapter 3, Working with Text. The use of graphic

styles is covered in Chapter 6, Formatting Graphic Objects. See also “Working with styles in

Impress” on page 45.

34 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Working with slide masters

Impress comes with a collection of slide masters. These slide masters are shown in the Master

Pages section of the Tasks pane (Figure 20). This section has three subsections: Used in This

Presentation, Recently Used, and Available for Use. Click the expand marker (usually a downwardpointing triangle or + sign) next to the name of a subsection to expand it and show thumbnails of the slides, or click the collapse marker (usually an upward-pointing triangle or a – sign) to collapse the subsection to hide the thumbnails.

Each of the slide masters shown in the Available for Use list is from a template of the same name.

If you have created your own templates, or added templates from other sources, slide masters

from those templates will also appear in this list. See “Working with templates” on page 45 for more

information about templates.

Figure 20: Slide (page) masters in Tasks Pane

Figure 21: Master View toolbar

Creating slide masters

You can create a new slide master which is similar to modifying the default slide master.

1) Enable editing of slide masters by selecting View > Master > Slide Master on the main

menu bar and the Master View toolbar opens (Figure 21). If the Master View toolbar does

not appear, go to View > Toolbars and select Master View.

2) Alternatively, right-click on a slide master in the Master Pages section of the tasks pane that you want to use and select Edit Master to open the Master View toolbar.

3) On the Master View toolbar, click the New Master icon .

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 35

4) A new slide master appears in the Slides pane. Modify this slide master to suit your requirements.

5) It is also recommended that you rename this new slide master. Right-click on the slide in the Slides pane and select Rename master from the context menu.

6) When finished creating a slide master, click Close Master View on the Master View toolbar and return to normal slide editing mode.

Applying a slide master

To apply a slide master to all the slides in your presentation:

1) In the Tasks Pane, make sure the Master Pages section is showing (Figure 20).

2) To apply one of the slide masters to all slides in your presentation, right-click on it from the available selection and select Apply to All Slides on the context menu.

To apply a different slide master to one or more selected slides:

1) In the Slide Pane, select the slide or slides where you want to use a new slide master.

2) In the Tasks Pane, right-click on the slide master you want to apply to the selected slides, and select Apply to Selected Slides on the context menu.

Loading additional slide masters

Sometimes, in the same set of slides, you may need to mix multiple slide masters that may belong

to different templates (the use of templates is explained in “Working with templates” on page 45).

For example, you may need a completely different layout for the first slide of the presentation, or you may want to add a slide from a different presentation to your current presentation (based on a template available on the hard disk).

1) Go to Format > Slide Design on the main menu bar or right-click on a slide in the Slides

Pane and select Slide Design from the context menu to open the Slide Design dialog

(Figure 22). This dialog shows the slide masters already available for use.

36

Figure 22: Slide Design

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

2) To add more slide masters, click the Load button to open the Load Slide Design dialog

(Figure 23).

Figure 23: Load Slide Design dialog

3) Select in the Load Slide Design dialog the template from which to load the slide master and click OK.

4) Click OK again to close the Slide Design dialog.

5) The slide masters in the template you selected to use are now shown in the Available for

use subsection of Master Pages.

Note

The slide masters you have loaded will also be available the next time you load the presentation. If you want to delete the unused slide masters, click the corresponding checkbox in the Slide Design dialog. If the slide master was not used in the presentation, it is removed from the list of available slide masters.

Tip

To limit the size of the presentation file, you may want to minimize the number of slide masters used.

Modifying a slide master

The following items can be changed on a slide master:

Background (color, gradient, hatching, or bitmap)

Background objects (for example, adding a logo or decorative graphics)

Text attributes for the main text area and notes

Size, placement, and contents of header and footer elements to appear on every slide

Size and placement of default frames for slide titles and content

To select the slide master for modification:

1) Select View > Master > Slide Master from the main menu bar. This unlocks the properties

of a slide master so you can edit it as shown in Figure 24.

2) Select a slide master in Master Pages in the Tasks pane.

3) Right-click on the slide master you want to modify and select Edit Master from the context menu.

4) Make changes as required to the slide master, then click the Close Master View icon on the Master View toolbar or go to View > Normal on the main menu bar to exit from editing slide masters.

5) Save your presentation file before continuing.

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 37

Caution

Figure 24: Example master view

Any changes made to one slide when in Master View mode will appear on all slides using this slide master. Always make sure you close Master View and return to

Normal view before working on any of the presentation slides. Select View >

Normal from the menu bar, or clicking Close Master View in the Master View toolbar to return to the normal slide view.

The changes made to one of the slides in Normal view (for example, changes to the bullet point style, the color of the title area, and so on) will not be overridden by subsequent changes to the slide master. There are cases, however, where it is desirable to revert a manually modified element of the slide to the style defined in the slide master: to do that, select that element and choose

Format > Default Formatting from the main menu bar.

It is also possible to modify the default layout of the slide master, for example by moving the title to the side; however, you are restricted to modifications to the “Title, Text” layout (that is, the layout containing a title box and a text box).

Sometimes, depending on the contents of the slide, you may want to apply a different layout. The title and text boxes will inherit the properties of the slide master, but if you have changed the position of these text boxes in the slide master, the layout may appear corrupted and you may need to re-position some of the layout elements manually.

Selecting and applying backgrounds

Backgrounds can be applied to a number of elements in Impress: the page, a default text area, a graphic object and so on. The procedures to apply a background are always the same and the following procedure is used to apply a background to the page.

1) Select Format > Page on the main menu bar. On the Page Setup dialog, select the

Background tab (Figure 25).

2) Alternatively, select Format > Styles and Formatting from the main menu bar, or press

F11, or click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Line and Filling toolbar to open the

Styles and Formatting dialog (Figure 26).

38 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 25: Background options in Page Setup dialog

Figure 26: Presentation Styles

Figure 27: Selecting a background color in the Page Setup dialog

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 39

3) Select the Presentation Styles icon and right-click Background and select Modify from the context menu. This opens the Background dialog, which has one tab (Area) and offers the same options as the Background tab in the Page Setup dialog.

4) Select the type of fill you want for your background from the five options in the drop-down menu: None, Color, Gradient, Hatching, or Bitmap.

5) A list of options for the selected fill type then appears. Figure 27 shows an example of

background colors.

6) Select one of the options on the Fill list and click OK. The option you have selected is added to the slide master, replacing any previously selected fill.

Tip

You can make custom additions to each type of background, with the obvious exception of None. After you create new fills, they are listed in the Background dialog along with the fills provided with LibreOffice, see Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic

Objects for more information.

Adding background objects

This section describes how to add background objects and graphic elements (such as a logo, decorative lines, and so on). LibreOffice supports a large number of graphic formats.

When you want the same graphic to appear on every slide of your presentation, the easiest and quickest solution is to use the slide master. It saves time while creating the presentation and when you want to modify or reposition the graphic on all the slides. If the same graphic is added to each slide manually, these operations have to be performed on each individual slide in the presentation.

For example, one of the most common actions in preparing a presentation is to add a picture to the slide master. To insert a picture already available on the computer, follow these steps:

1) Select View > Master > Slide Master on the main menu bar to open the master view.

2) Select Insert > Picture > From File on the main menu bar to open the file browser.

3) Navigate to the directory where your picture is located and select it. If you want to see a preview, select the Preview checkbox in the file browser dialog.

4) Click Open and the picture is placed into your slide.

Once the picture is inserted onto your slide, you need to move it to the background as follows:

1) With the picture selected, right-click on the picture and select Arrange > Send to Back from the context menu.

2) Reposition the picture and, if necessary, modify its size. See Chapter 4 Adding and

Formatting Pictures for more information.

In addition to pictures you can add a number of other background objects, for example decorative lines, text and shapes.

Caution

LibreOffice offers the option to insert a picture as a link to the file rather than embedding it in the document. This can be useful when a presentation is not intended for distribution onto other computers, but where it will remain in the same computer and directory structure. For example, it could be created on a notebook computer, which is to be used to give the presentation to a group of clients.

However, if the presentation file is to be distributed onto other computers, the picture must be embedded to avoid the “missing picture” syndrome when the presentation is given on a different computer.

40 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Tip

Tip

If you want the image to blend with the background, you can set the background color of the picture as transparent. Select the picture, then Tools > Color Replacer from the main menu bar. Select the first checkbox, move the mouse cursor onto the picture and click on the color you want to make transparent. This color appears next to the checkbox. Make sure that Replace with... is set to Transparent and click Replace.

An easy way to make the picture lighter so that the text stands out better against its background, is to increase the transparency of the picture or change the gamma luminance of the picture. Both these adjustments can be quickly made from the

Picture toolbar.

Slide master styles

Within the slide master you can define a complete set of styles for the default appearance of text and graphic objects inserted in slides based on that background. If for example your slide master has a dark background, you may want to set the font color of the title and text areas to be light.

Rather than manually changing the font color for every new slide you create, a time-consuming operation prone to errors and omissions, simply modify the style in the slide master. Changes made to styles in the slide master only apply to the slides based on that particular slide master.

To work on the slide master styles, press F11, or select Format > Styles and Formatting from the main menu, or click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Line and Filling toolbar to open the

Styles and Formatting dialog (Figure 26 for Presentation styles and Figure 28 for Graphic styles).

The Styles and Formatting dialog is a floating dialog. Press F11 to close the Styles and Formatting dialog when you do not need it. LibreOffice will remember its position the next time you open the

Styles and Formatting dialog.

Styles in Impress are sub-divided into two main categories: Presentation styles and Graphics

styles.

Figure 28: Graphic Styles and Formatting dialog

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 41

Presentation styles

Presentation styles (Figure 26) affect three elements of a slide master: the background,

background objects (such as icons, decorative lines, and text frames), and the text placed on the slide. Text styles are further divided into Notes, Outline 1 through Outline 9, Subtitle, and Title. The outline styles are used for the different levels of the outline to which they belong. For example,

Outline 2 is used for the sub-points of Outline 1, and Outline 3 is used for the sub-points of Outline

2.

The presentation styles can be modified, but new presentation styles cannot be created.

Graphics styles

Graphics styles (Figure 28) apply to lines, shapes and text boxes created using the Impress

drawing tools and define the formatting of such objects. You can create additional styles or modify the included styles.

Note

The presence of text and title styles both in the Presentation and Graphics styles may seem confusing. This apparent duplication is because Impress uses special text boxes when adding structured text to slides where Presentation styles apply

(AutoLayout boxes). The title and other text styles in Graphics styles continue to apply to other text boxes you may want to add, or to text associated with shapes or lines.

Tip

At the bottom of the Styles and Formatting dialog is a drop-down list where you can choose to show either Hierarchical, All Styles, Hidden Styles, Applied Styles or

Custom Styles in the dialog window.

Modifying default text areas

When a slide master is opened for editing, it contains five areas, as shown in Figure 24 on page

38.

Title area for AutoLayouts

Object area for AutoLayouts

Date area

Footer area

Slide number area

Position and size

Click with the left mouse button on any of these areas to display the selection handles around the rectangle. Use these handles to modify the size and position of the area.

To change the position, move the mouse towards one of the edges, not on a selection handle, and click the left mouse button. The cursor changes shape which is dependent on your computer setup (normally a clenched hand).

To modify the shape and size of one of the rectangular areas, use one of the selection handles. The corner handles modify the height and width of the rectangle simultaneously while the side handles modify only one dimension at a time. The shape of the mouse cursor usually changes shape when over a handle, giving a clear visual indication of how it will affect the shape of the rectangular area.

42 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Tip

To keep the shape of the rectangular area constant, move the mouse to one of the four corner handles and keep the Shift key pressed while dragging the handle with the mouse. The rectangle maintains the ratio between the width and height dimensions of the rectangle.

To accurately control the shape and size as well as the position of the default text area, it is better to use the Position and Size dialog than the mouse.

1) Select the rectangular area by clicking on the border.

2) Press F4, or go to Format > Position and Size on the main menu bar, or right-click on the border and select Position and Size from the context menu to open the Position and Size

dialog (Figure 29).

Figure 29: Position and Size dialog

The functions of this dialog are explained in the Draw Guide, so only short descriptions of the most important fields are provided in this chapter.

Use the Position section to specify the X (horizontal) and Y (vertical) position of the rectangular area. The values represent the distance of the selected base point and the default position is the top left corner of the slide.

Use the Size section to specify the width and height of the rectangular area. In the Base

point section, select a point on the rectangular area that you do not want to move while resizing. The default setting of top left corner means that the position of the top left corner of the area will not change after resizing.

Use the Rotation page of the dialog to rotate the default text area. For example, you can place the footer area on the side by rotating each text area by 90 degrees and obtain a more modern-looking layout. In general it is preferable to use only right angles for ease of editing, although the program does not impose restrictions on the values that can be used.

Background, border, arrangement and alignment

Besides the shape, size and position, it is also possible to modify other aspects of the editable areas on the slide master, such as the background, border, alignment relative to the slide, and position relative to other objects.

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 43

While the background style and line style of an area can be accessed from the Format menu, to access the Alignment and Arrange menus you need either to click on the Arrange and

Alignment icons on the Line and Filling toolbar or right-click on the border to open the context menu.

Date and slide number

The date area and slide number area do not automatically appear on every slide, even if you have defined them. To show them on every slide:

1) Close the Master View.

2) Select the desired field from the main menu: Insert > Page number or Insert > Date and

time. See Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts for more information.

Adding text to all slides

Some of the supplied slide masters have text objects in the footer. You can add other text objects to the master page for your slides to act as a header or a footer.

1) Go to View > Master > Slide Master from the main menu bar to open Master View.

2) On the Drawing toolbar, select the Text icon or press F2.

3) Click once in the master page and drag to draw a text object.

4) Type or paste your text into the text object or add fields as described below.

5) Click Close Master View on the Master View toolbar or go to View > Normal on the main menu bar when you are finished.

To add a field, such as the date or page number (slide number), to a text object in the header or footer, select Insert > Fields. and select the required field from the submenu. If you want to edit a field in your slide, see Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text for more information.

The fields you can use in Impress are:

Date (fixed)

Date (variable): updates automatically when you reload the file

Time (fixed)

Time (variable): updates automatically when you reload the file

Author: first and last names listed in the LibreOffice user data

Page number (slide number)

File name

Tip

To change the number format (1,2,3 or a,b,c or i,ii,iii, etc.) for the page number field, go to Format > Page on the main menu bar and select a format from the list in the

Layout Settings area.

To change the author information, go to Tools > Options > LibreOffice > User Data on the main menu bar.

44 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Working with styles in Impress

If you are familiar with styles in Writer, you will find both similarities and differences in Impress. The presentation styles are comparable to paragraph styles in Writer and are used in a similar fashion.

You cannot create new presentation styles but you can fully configure the existing ones. Note that, as with the Heading styles in Writer, the Outline styles are hierarchically linked, so that a change in the Outline 1 will cascade through all the other Outline levels.

In Impress you will also find the graphics styles very useful. They define the characteristics of a graphic object (including a text object). For example, ifyou need to create an organization chart diagram in one of the slides of your presentation, you will probably want all of the objects to have a consistent appearance, such as line style, font type, shadow, and so on. The easiest way to achieve this result with the minimum effort is to create a graphics style for the objects and apply it to each object. The major benefit is that if you decide to change, say, the background color of objects, all you need to do is modify the style rather than each individual object.

Presentation styles are discussed in detail in Chapter 3 Working with Text and graphics styles are discussed in detail in Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects. More information on styles can also be found in the Getting Started Guide Chapter 3 Using Styles and Templates.

Working with templates

A template is a document model that you use to create other documents. For example, you can create a template for business presentations that has your company logo on the first slide so that new presentations created using this template will have your company logo on the first slide.

Templates can contain anything that regular documents can contain, such as text, graphics, a set of styles, and user-specific setup information such as measurement units, language, the default printer, and toolbar and menu customization.

All documents created using LibreOffice are based on templates. You can create a specific template for any document type (text, spreadsheet, drawing, presentation). If you do not specify a template when you start a new document, then the document is based on the default template for that type of document. If you have not specified a default template, LibreOffice uses the blank template for that type of document that is installed with LibreOffice. This default template can be

changed, see “Setting default template” on page 48 for more information.

However, Impress is a little different from other LibreOffice components, in that it starts with the

Presentation Wizard, unless you have decided to turn off this wizard. When you choose File >

New > Presentation from the menu bar and, if the wizard is active, it opens offering several choices for a new presentation, one of which is From template.

If you have turned off the Presentation Wizard, when you start a new presentation by choosing File

> New > Presentation from the menu bar, LibreOffice uses the default presentation template. If you have not defined your own default template, LibreOffice uses the blank template supplied with

Impress.

For more information on templates, see the Getting Started Guide Chapter 3 Using Styles and

Templates.

Templates supplied with LibreOffice

Impress comes with a set of predefined templates and these are located in the Presentation

backgrounds folder. These templates only contain backgrounds and background objects providing you with a starting point to create your own templates. Any templates that you create from this default set will be located in the My Templates folder when you save your presentation as a template.

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 45

Create a new presentation from a presentation template as follows:

1) Go to File > New > Templates on the main menu bar to open the Template Manager dialog

(Figure 30).

2) Click on the Presentations tab.

3) Navigate to the selection of presentation templates you want to use.

4) Double-click the name of the template in the list and a new presentation will be created using the selected template,

Figure 30: Template Manager dialog for presentations

Templates from other sources

You can download templates for LibreOffice from many sources, including the official template repository at http://templates.libreoffice.org/ , and install them on your computer. On other websites you may find collections of templates that have been packaged into extension (.OXT) files. These are installed a bit differently (using the Extension Manager), as described below.

Some of these templates are free of charge; others are available for a fee. Check the descriptions to see what licenses and fees apply to the ones that interest you.

If you have created your own templates, they are stored in the My Templates folder. To import

individual templates, see “Importing a template” on page 51 for more information and to import a

template collection, see “Importing template collections” on page 52 for more information.

The slide masters created by newly created or imported templates will appear in Available for Use in the Master Pages section of the Tasks Pane.

Creating your own templates

To create a template from a presentation and save it to My Templates folder :

1) Open the presentation that you want to use for a template.

2) Add any extra content and styles to your presentation.

3) Go to File > Save As Template on the main menu bar to open the Template Manager

dialog (Figure 31).

46 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

4) Select the My Templates folder to activate the Save icon , then click the Save icon. If

the My Templates folder is not visible, see “Saving templates to a hidden folder” on page 47

for more information.

5) Type a name for the new template in the Enter template name text box.

6) Click Accept to save the new template in the My Templates folder.

7) Close the Template Manager dialog.

Figure 31: Saving new template in Template Manager dialog

Saving templates to a hidden folder

This procedure is for a LibreOffice installation that has yet to have any user created or imported templates for use in Impress. Any empty template folders are hidden in the Template Manager and a work-around is necessary to save the first template into the My Templates folder.

1) Go to File > Save As Template on the main menu bar to open the Template Manager dialog. By default the Template Manager opens at the Documents page.

2) Double click on the MediaWiki folder to select it and activate the Save icon the Save icon.

, then click

3) Specify the template name in the pop-up dialog and click Accept. The template is saved into the MediaWiki folder. This appears in the MediaWiki folder on the dialog page of the file type being saved, which is Presentations.

4) Close the Template Manager dialog.

5) Go to File > New > Templates on the main menu bar to open the Template Manager dialog again.

Note

Closing and opening the Template Manager is necessary so that the following steps can be carried out to move your template into the My Templates folder.

6) Select the Presentations tab to open the dialog page for presentations (Figure 32).

7) Double-click the MediaWiki folder to open it.

8) Select the template you have just added and the file handling controls are displayed.

9) Click the Move to folder icon and select My Templates from the drop list that appears. Your template will be moved from the MediaWiki folder to the My Templates folder.

10) Close the Template Manager dialog.

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 47

Figure 32: Moving templates to My Templates folder

Setting default template

If you create a presentation by using File > New > Presentation on the main menu bar and do not select a template, LibreOffice creates the presentation from the default Impress template, which is normally a blank template. However, you can set any presentation template to be the default template, even a template that you have created, so long as it is located in a folder displayed in the

Template Manager dialog. You can always reset to the default template back to the blank template later if you choose.

Setting a custom template as default

To set a template that you have created or imported as default instead of using the Impress default template:

1) Go to File > New > Templates to open the Template Manager dialog and select the

Presentations tab (Figure 32).

2) Double click on the My Templates folder to open it.

3) Select the template you want to use as the default template.

4) Click the Set as default icon and your chosen template becomes the default template.

Resetting default template

To reset the default template for a new presentation to use the Impress default template:

1) Go to File > New > Templates to open the Template Manager dialog.

2) Select the Action Menu icon and choose Reset Default Template from the drop-

down menu (Figure 33). This command does not appear unless the default template has

been previously changed to a template of your choosing.

3) Select Presentation from the drop down list to reset the default template. If other modules in LibreOffice have had their default template changed, then the modules will also appear in this drop down list.

4) The next time that you create a new presentation using Impress, the presentation will be created from the default Impress template.

48 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 33: Resetting default template

Editing a template

You can edit template styles and content, and then, if you wish, you can reapply the template styles to presentations that were created from that template.

Note

You can only reapply styles. You cannot reapply content.

Editing

1) Go to File > New > Templates to open the Template Manager dialog.

2) Navigate to the template that you want to edit and click once on it to activate the file

handling controls (Figure 32).

3) Select the Edit icon and the template opens in Impress.

4) Edit the template just as you would any other presentation. To save your changes, go to

File > Save on the main menu bar.

Updating a document from a changed template

The next time that you open a presentation that was created from the changed template, the

following message appears (Figure 34).

Click Update Styles to update any styles in the template that have been changed in the document.

Click Keep Old Styles if you do not want to update any styles in the template that have been changed in the document. Whichever option you choose, the message box closes and the presentation opens in Impress.

Caution

Figure 34. Update styles message

If you choose Keep Old Styles in the message box shown in Figure 34, that

message will not appear again the next time you open the document after changing the template it is based on. You will not get another chance to update the styles from the template, although you can use the macro given in the Note below to re-enable this feature.

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 49

Note

To re-enable updating from a template:

1) Use Tools

> Macros > Organize Macros >

LibreOffice Basic. Select the document from the list, click the expansion symbol (+ or triangle), and select

Standard. If Standard has an expansion symbol beside it, click that and select a module.

2) If the Edit button is active, click it. If the Edit button is not active, click New.

3) In the Basic window, enter the following:

Sub FixDocV3

' set UpdateFromTemplate

oDocSettings = ThisComponent.createInstance( _

"com.sun.star.document.Settings" )

oDocSettings.UpdateFromTemplate = True

End Sub 'FixDocV3

4) Click the Run BASIC icon, then close the Basic window.

5) Save the document.

The next time you open this document, you will be prompted to update the styles from the modified template.

Organizing templates

LibreOffice can only use templates that are in LibreOffice template folders. You can create new

LibreOffice template folders and use them to organize your templates. For example, you might have separate template folders for different purposes or projects. You can also import and export templates.

Note

All the actions available from the Commands button in the Template Management dialog can also be carried out by right-clicking on the templates or the folders.

Tip

The location of LibreOffice template folders varies with your computer’s operating system. To learn where the template folders are stored on your computer, go to

Tools > Options > LibreOffice > Paths.

Creating a template folder

To create a template folder:

1) Go to File > New > Templates on the main menu bar to open the Template Management dialog.

2) Select the Presentations tab to open the dialog page for presentations (Figure 32 on page

48).

3) Click on the template you want to move to a new folder and the file handling controls are displayed.

4) Click the Move to folder icon and select New folder from the drop list that appears.

5) In the pop-up dialog, type a name for the new folder and click Accept.

6) The selected template is then moved to the new folder you have just created.

Deleting a template folder

You cannot delete the template folders supplied with LibreOffice or installed using the Extension

Manager. You can only delete folders that you have created.

50 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

To delete a template folder that you have created:

1) In the Template Management dialog select the folder that you want to delete.

2) Select the Delete icon deletion. Click Yes.

and a message box appears and asks you to confirm the

Caution

Folders which contain no files are hidden. If the folder is visible, ensure that you want to delete the files that are inside. You may have to put a dummy template into an empty folder to delete it. Just select File > Save As Template for any file you have opened, move it into the folder to be deleted, and then delete the folder.

Moving a template

To move a template from one template folder to another template folder:

1) In the Template Manager dialog, double-click the folder that contains the template you want

to move (Figure 32 on page 48).

2) Select the template that you want to move.

3) Click the Move to folder icon and select the folder from the drop down list to move your selected template.

Deleting a template

You cannot delete the templates supplied with LibreOffice or installed using the Extension

Manager. You can only delete templates that you have created or imported.

To delete a template:

1) In the Template Manager dialog, double-click the folder that contains the template you want to delete.

2) Select the template that you want to delete.

3) Select the Delete icon deletion. Click Yes.

and a message box appears and asks you to confirm the

Importing a template

If the template that you want to use is in a different location, you must import it into an LibreOffice template folder.

To import a template into a template folder:

1) In the Template Manager dialog, select the folder into which you want to import the template.

2) Select the Import icon and a standard file browser dialog opens.

3) Navigate to the template that you want to import, select it and click Open. The file browser window closes and the template appears in the selected folder.

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates 51

Importing template collections

The Extension Manager provides an easy way to install collections of templates that have been packaged as extensions. For more about the Extension Manager, see the Getting Started Guide

Chapter 14 Customizing LibreOffice.

Figure 35: Extension Manager

1) Download the extension package (.OXT file) and save it anywhere on your computer. You can find several templates at http://templates.libreoffice.org/template-center that have been developed for use with LibreOffice.

2) Go to Tools > Extension Manager on the main menu bar to open the Extension Manager

dialog (Figure 35).

3) Click Add to open a file browser window.

4) Find and select the template package you want to install and click Open. The package begins installing. You may be asked to accept a license agreement.

5) When the package installation is complete, the templates are available for use through File

> New > Templates and the extension is listed in the Extension Manager.

Exporting a template

To export a template from a template folder to another location:

1) In the Template Manager dialog, double-click the folder that contains the template you want to export.

2) Select the template that you want to export.

3) Click the Export icon and a standard file browser dialog opens.

4) Navigate to the folder into which you want to export the template and click OK.

52 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Chapter

3

Adding and Formatting Text

Introduction

Any text used in slides is contained in text boxes. This chapter describes how to create, modify, use, and delete text boxes. It also discusses the various types of text that can be inserted and explains how to format the text. Finally, it provides information on how to insert special forms of text such as numbered or bulleted lists, tables, fields, and hyperlinks.

Working with text boxes

There are two ways of adding text boxes to slides:

Choose a predefined layout from the Layouts section of the Tasks pane containing text elements as described in Chapter 1 Introducing Impress. These text boxes are called

AutoLayout text boxes.

Create a text box using the text tool in the Drawing toolbar or the Text toolbar.

Entering text into AutoLayout text boxes

To enter text into an AutoLayout text box:

1) Make sure Normal view is selected.

2) Click in the text box that reads Click to add text.

3) Type or paste your text into the AutoLayout text box.

For more information on AutoLayout text boxes, see “Creating bulleted and numbered lists” on page 69 for more information.

Entering text into text boxes

To enter text into a text box created using the text tool:

1) Make sure Normal View is selected.

2) Click on the Text icon

on the Drawing toolbar (Figure 36) or the Text toolbar (Figure 37).

The default position of the drawing toolbar is towards the bottom of the screen. If the

Drawing or Text toolbars with the text icon are not visible, got View > Toolbars > Drawing or Text on the main menu bar.

3) Click in the slide and drag to draw a text box setting the width. Do not worry about the height because the text box will expand as you type.

4) To reposition the text box to a different part of the slide, see “Moving text boxes” on page

55; to change the width, see “Resizing text boxes” on page 56.

5) Release the mouse button when finished. The cursor appears in the text box, which is now

in edit mode and shows a hashed border (Figure 38).

6) Type or paste your text in the text box.

7) Click outside the text box to deselect it.

Note

In addition to the normal text boxes where text is horizontally aligned, it is possible to insert text boxes where the text is aligned vertically. Click on the Vertical Text icon

in the drawing toolbar (Figure 36) to create a vertical text box. The Vertical Text

tool is available only when Asian languages are enabled in Tools > Options >

Language Settings > Languages on the main menu bar.

54 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 36: Drawing Toolbar

Figure 37: Text toolbar

Figure 38: Entering text in a text box

Moving text boxes

In Normal view, the cursor changes from an arrow to an I-beam (depending on your computer setup) as you move it over the text in a text box.

1) Click when the pointer becomes an I-beam. The text box is now in edit mode. In this mode

a hashed border is visible around the text box edges (Figure 38).

2) Move the cursor over the hashed border and it changes shape, becoming the usual “move” symbol for your operating system (for example, a hand).

3) When the “move” symbol appears, click once and selection handles appear around the

border (Figure 39).

Figure 39: Moving text boxes

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 55

4) Click anywhere on the hashed border and drag to move the text box. A semi-transparent copy of the text box shows where your text box will be placed. Do not click on a selection handle as this will not move the text box, but resize the text box.

5) Release the mouse button when the text box is in the desired position. To return to edit mode, click outside the text box area.

Resizing text boxes

In Normal view, the cursor changes from an arrow to an I-beam (depending on your computer setup) as you move it over the text in a text box.

1) Click when the pointer becomes an I-beam. The text box is now in edit mode. In this mode

a hashed border is visible around the text box edges (Figure 38).

2) Move the cursor over the hashed border and it changes shape, becoming the usual “move” symbol for your operating system (for example, a hand).

3) When the “move” symbol appears, click once and selection handles appear around the

border (Figure 40).

4) Move the pointer over any handle. The cursor changes shape, indicating in which direction the text box will be resized. The corner handles change the two dimensions of the text box simultaneously, while the four handles at the center of each side modify only one dimension.

5) When the two-headed arrow is displayed, click and drag to resize the text box. As you resize the text box, a dashed outline appears indicating the new size of the text box.

6) Release the mouse button when the text box is at the desired size. To return to edit mode, click outside the text box area.

Tip

Figure 40: Resizing text boxes

To maintain the proportions of a text box while resizing, press and hold the Shift key, then click and drag. Make sure to release the mouse button before releasing the

Shift key.

Using the Position and Size dialog

For more accurate control over the size and position of a text box, use the Position and Size dialog instead of using the mouse.

56 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 41: Position and Size dialog

1) Select the text box, then press F4, or select Format > Position and Size from the main menu bar, or right-click and select Position and Size from the context menu to open the

Position and Size dialog (Figure 41).

2) Use the Position section of the dialog to specify the X (horizontal) and Y (vertical) position of the text box. The values represent the distance of the base point relative to the top left corner of the slide.

3) Use the Size section of the dialog to specify the width and height of the text box. The values represent the distance of the base point relative to the top left corner of the slide. To maintain the ratio of width to height, select the Keep ratio option.

4) Select one of nine base points that correspond to the selection handles on the text box and the center of the text box. The default selection is the top left corner of a text box.

5) To prevent accidental modification of the position or size of the text box, select the Position and/or Size options in the Protect section of the dialog.

6) To allow the text box to adjust its height and/or width as you enter text, select Fit width to

text and/or Fit height to text in the Adapt section of the dialog.

7) Click OK and you text box is moved or re-positioned on your slide.

Note

The unit of measurement for this dialog and other dialogs used in Impress is set in

Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress > General on the main menu bar.

Deleting text boxes

1) Click the text once to display the hashed border.

2) Move the cursor to the edge of the text box and click. The hashed border now shows the selection handles.

3) Press Delete.

Tip

Sometimes it is faster to to delete a text box by dragging a selection rectangle around the text box and then hitting the Delete key. Take care to avoid selecting and accidentally deleting other text boxes or shapes.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 57

Inserting text

Pasting text

Text may be inserted into the text box by copying it from another document and pasting it into

Impress. However, the pasted text will probably not match the formatting of the surrounding text or that of the other slides in the presentation. This may be what you want on some occasions; however in most cases you may want to make sure that the presentation style is consistent. There are several ways to ensure consistency and these methods are explained below.

Pasting text unformatted

It is good practice to paste text without formatting and apply the formatting later. After highlighting and copying the text, use one of these methods to paste the text into your slide without formatting:

Use the keyboard shortcut Control+Shift+V and select Unformatted text from the dialog that opens.

Click on the small triangle to the right of the Paste icon on the Standard toolbar and select Unformatted text from the context menu that opens.

Select Edit > Paste Special on the main menu bar and select Unformatted text from the dialog that opens.

The text will be pasted at the cursor position and formatted with the outline style in an AutoLayout text box or with the default graphic style in a normal text box.

Pasting text formatted

To paste text straight into an AutoLayout text box on your slide with its formatting retained, use one of these methods:

Use the keyboard shortcut Control+V.

Click on the Paste icon on the Standard toolbar.

Select Edit > Paste on the main menu bar.

The text will be pasted into your slide at the cursor position. To give the pasted text the same appearance as the rest of your presentation, apply the appropriate outline style to the text:

1) Select the text you have just pasted (see “Selecting text” on page 61 for more information).

2) Select Format > Default formatting on the menu bar. This operation assigns one of the nine Presentation styles to the text. The style depends on where the text was pasted into your slide.

3) Use the four positioning arrows

on the Text Formatting toolbar (Figure 42)

to move the text to the appropriate position and give it the appropriate outline level. The left arrow promotes the list entry by one level (for example from Outline 3 to Outline 2), the right arrow demotes the list entry by one level, the up and down arrows move the list entry.

4) Apply necessary manual formatting to the text changing font attributes, tabs, and so on.

Figure 42: Text Formatting toolbar

58 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

If you are pasting text into a normal text box, you can still use styles to quickly format the text. Note that only one graphic style can be applied to the copied text.

1) Paste the text in the desired position.

2) Select the text you have just pasted (see “Selecting text” on page 61 for more information).

3) Select the desired graphic style.

4) Apply necessary manual formatting to the text changing font attributes, tabs, and so on.

Tip

Presentation styles are very different from Writer styles and are applied differently.

Refer to “Using styles to format text“ on page 61 for details.

Inserting special characters

To insert special characters, such as copyright, math, geometric, or monetary symbols, or characters from another language:

1) Click at the position where you want to insert the special character into the text.

2) Select Insert > Special Character on the main menu bar to open the Special Characters

dialog (Figure 43). Alternatively, and if the Text Formatting toolbar has been customized,

click the Special Character icon to open the Special Characters dialog.

Tip

To show toolbar tools that are not visible on a toolbar, right-click in a blank area on the toolbar and select Visible Buttons from the context menu that opens. Click on the icon you wish to add to the toolbar.

3) Choose the font and character subset from the Font and Subset drop-down menus.

4) Click the character you want to insert. You may have to scroll to find the one you want.

5) Click OK.

Characters you selected will be inserted in the order they were selected, even if you accidentally click on the wrong character. Clicking on another character will only add it to the ones being inserted. Click Delete to delete all the characters selected and then click on the correct characters.

Alternatively, you can insert all the selected characters and then delete any unwanted characters from the slide because special characters behave like any other character.

Figure 43: Special Characters dialog

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 59

Inserting non-breaking spaces and hyphens

Where it is not desirable for words that are separated by a space or a hyphen to span over two lines, or where an optional hyphen is desired, you can insert a special formatting mark. To access

Formatting marks, select Insert > Formatting marks on the main menu bar. Impress supports the following formatting marks:

Non-breaking space – inserts a space that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.

Non-breaking hyphen – inserts a hyphen that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.

Optional hyphen – inserts an invisible hyphen within a word that will appear and create a line break once it becomes the last character in a line.

No-width optional break – inserts an invisible space within a word that will insert a line break once it becomes the last character in a line. Only available when complex text layout

(CTL) is enabled.

No-width no break – inserts an invisible space within a word that will keep the word together at the end of a line. Only available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.

Left-to-right mark – inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Only available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.

Right-to-left mark – inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Only available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.

Formatting text

Introduction

The appropriate use of text formatting can give a presentation a consistent look and a dynamic feel and it can even enhance the understanding of an audience by preventing any distracting elements in your message.

When you enter text, either in an AutoLayout text box or in a normal text box, it is formatted with a set of predefined attributes known as a style. The style used depends on the outline level of the point where the text was entered into a text box. For example, if you paste text at a level 2 position,

Impress will format it either according to the Outline 2 presentation style for AutoLayout text boxes or the Default Graphic style for text boxes.

Tip

Sometimes, as seen in the “Pasting text” section on page 58, it is very useful to

re-apply the baseline style to a selection of text eliminating any manual formatting applied to it, especially if you made a mistake and you do not know how to undo it. To use the baseline style, select the formatted text and then select Format > Default

formatting on the main menu bar.

Formatting text may require some intervention in three areas:

Character attributes (for example font color)

Paragraph attributes (for example alignment)

List attributes (for example type of bullet)

In some cases it is quicker and more efficient to apply manual formatting. However, in situations where you need to perform the same modifications to many different parts of the presentation, the use of styles is recommended. Both these techniques are described here.

60 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Note

Unlike LibreOffice Writer, where it is recommended to use styles whenever possible, in Impress manual formatting has to be used more often. This is because presentation styles are fixed in Impress. Therefore, it is not possible, for example, to have two different level 1s or different types of bullet points for the same outline level.

Also, the lack of support for character styles forces the use of manual formatting to modify sections of the text.

Selecting text

Text must be selected before it can be formatted. Any formatting changes will apply only to the selected text.

To format all the text in a text box, click once on the text, then click once on the border of the text box to display the selection handles. Now any formatting changes will apply to all the text in the text box.

To format only part of the text and after clicking once on the text, you can select text using one of the following methods:

Click and drag the cursor over the text to highlight the text.

Double click to select a complete word or triple click to select a whole paragraph.

Press and hold the Shift key and then use the keyboard arrow keys to extend your selection.

Tip

To select text word by word, instead of character by character, press the Ctrl key and

Shift key together. To speed up the selection even further, you can combine the Shift key with the Home key or the End key to extend the selection up to the start or end of the line in which the cursor is positioned, respectively.

Using styles to format text

Impress has two categories of styles: presentation styles and graphics styles. Presentation styles are used on text inserted into an AutoLayout text box, slide master backgrounds, and background objects. However, for text inserted in a text box or a graphic object, you need to apply a graphic style.

In this chapter we focus on Presentation styles. For information on graphic styles, see Chapter 6

Formatting Graphic Objects.

Modifying a presentation style

To modify a presentation style, follow these steps:

1) Open the Styles and Formatting dialog (Figure 44) by pressing F11 or selecting Format >

Styles and Formatting on the menu bar.

2) Make sure the Presentation Styles icon is selected.

3) Right-click on the style to be modified and select Modify from the context menu. The

tabbed pages available in this dialog for modifying a presentation style are shown in Figure

45.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 61

Figure 44: Presentation Styles and Formatting

Figure 45: Dialog for modifying a presentation style

This modifying dialog consists of fifteen tabbed pages, which can be divided in two groups: pages that determine formatting of the text, and pages that determine the properties of slide master background and background objects.

There is no difference between attributes that determine a style and attributes used manually on portions of text. In fact the pages that open when manually applying formatting are the same that you use when configuring styles in the Styles and Formatting dialog. Therefore, once you master the formatting of text, you will know how to create and modify a style.

For the Font and Font Effects style pages, refer to “Formatting characters” on page 63.

For the Indents and Spacing, Alignment, and Tabs style pages, refer to “Formatting paragraphs” on page 65.

For the Bullet and numbering type, Graphics, Customize style pages, refer to “Creating bulleted and numbered lists” on page 69.

The pages that relate to formatting background and background objects are described in detail in

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects.

Updating a style from a selection

To update a style from a portion of text that you have just modified or would like to use:

1) Select an item in a text box that has the format you want to adopt as a style.

2) In the Styles and Formatting dialog (Figure 44), select the style you want to update and

then click the Update Style icon .

Applying a presentation style

To apply a presentation style, move the paragraph to the appropriate outline level as described in

“Creating bulleted and numbered lists” on page 69.This is different from Writer, where you select

the desired style from the Styles and Formatting window.

62 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Formatting characters

To view the character formatting options, select Format > Character on the main menu bar or click the Character icon

on the Text Formatting toolbar (Figure 42) and the Character dialog opens

(Figure 46). If Text Formatting toolbar is not visible, choose View > Toolbars > Text Formatting.

Note that character styles do not exist in Impress.

Font page

Use the Font page to select the desired font type, its base attributes (Italic, Bold, etc.) as well as the size. A sample of the font is displayed in the lower part of the dialog. You can also specify the language of this style. This font page is also available when creating or modifying a presentation style or a graphics style.

Tip

When writing a presentation in multiple languages, you can use the language setting to create two styles that only differ in the language but are otherwise the same. This allows you to check the spelling of all of the contents without affecting appearance.

If support for Asian language and Complex Text Layout (CTL) font has been enabled (Tools >

Options > Language Settings > Languages), then Asian text font and CTL text font are available in the Character dialog. Each part of the Character dialog has the same functionality, so you can specify the Asian and CTL text fonts and their attributes as well as Western text fonts.

Figure 46: Font page in Character dialog with Asian and CTL fonts enabled

Font Effects page

Use the Font Effects page (Figure 47) to apply special effects to the text, such as over lining and

underlining, color, shadow and so on. As for the Font page, a sample of the text is displayed in the lower part of the dialog, providing a quick visual check of the effects applied. This page is also available when creating or modifying a presentation style or a graphics style.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 63

Figure 47: Font Effects page in Character dialog

Position page

The Position page (Figure 48) has advanced options to customize text. Use this page to set the

text position relative to the baseline when you need to insert subscripts or superscripts. This page is not available when creating or modifying a presentation style or a graphics style.

64

Figure 48: Position page in Character dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

In Position, create a superscript or a subscript as follows:

1) Select Superscript or Subscript as applicable.

2) Specify the amount as a percentage by which the text should be raised (superscripts) or lowered (subscripts). If Automatic is selected, this option is not available.

3) Specify the percentage of the character to be used relative to the baseline character size.

The other attributes that can be set on this page are as follows:

Scale width in Rotation – specifies the percentage of the font width by which to horizontally stretch or compress the individual characters of the selected text.

Spacing – specifies the spacing between the characters of the selected text. For expanded or condensed spacing, enter the amount that you want to expand or condense the text in the by box using the options from the drop-down list.

Default – uses the character spacing specified in the font type

Expanded – increases the character spacing

Condensed – decreases the character spacing

Pair kerning – automatically adjust the character spacing for specific letter combinations. Kerning is only available for certain font types and requires that your printer support this option.

Formatting paragraphs

To view the paragraph formatting options, select Format > Paragraph on the main menu bar or click the Paragraph icon

on the Text Formatting toolbar (Figure 42) and the Paragraph dialog

opens (Figure 49). If the Text Formatting toolbar is not visible, select View > Toolbars > Text

Formatting on the main menu bar.

Normally the paragraph formatting dialog contains three pages: Indents and Spacing; Alignment and Tabs. However, if Asian language support has been enabled in Tools> Options > Language

Settings > Languages, a page called Asian Typography is also becomes available.

Indents and Spacing

The Indents and Spacing page has four sections and is also available in Presentation Styles dialog and Graphics Styles dialog.

Indent – specifies the amount of space to leave between the left and the right page margins and the paragraph.

Before text – enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin.

After text – enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin.

First line – indents the first line of a paragraph by the amount that you enter. To create a hanging indent enter a positive value for Before text and a negative value for First line.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 65

66

Figure 49: Indents and Spacing in Paragraph dialog

Spacing – specifies the amount of space to leave between selected paragraphs.

Above paragraph – enter the amount of space that you want to leave above the selected paragraph(s).

Below paragraph – enter the amount of space that you want to leave below the selected paragraph(s).

Note

Do not add space between paragraphs of the same style. This makes any space specified before or after a paragraph not to be applied when the preceding and following paragraphs are of the same paragraph style.

Line spacing – specifies the amount of space to leave between lines of text in a paragraph. The options available from the drop down list are as follows:

Single – applies single line spacing to the current paragraph. This is the default setting.

1.5 lines – sets the line spacing to 1.5 lines.

Double – sets the line spacing to two lines.

Proportional – select this option and then enter a percentage value in the box, where

100% corresponds to single line spacing.

At Least – sets the minimum line spacing to the value that you enter in the box. If you use different font sizes within a paragraph, the line spacing is automatically adjusted to the largest font size. If you prefer to have identical spacing for all lines, specify a value in At Least that corresponds to the largest font size.

Leading – sets the height of the vertical space that is inserted between two lines.

Fixed – enter a fixed value to be used for line spacing.

Tip

Setting the line spacing to less than 100% is a good method to place a lot of text into a text box when space is limited. However, care must be taken as too small a value will make the text hard to read.

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Tip

You can change the default unit of measurement, for example from inches to centimeters, in Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress > General on the main menu bar.

Alignment

Use the Alignment page (Figure 50) to determine the paragraph alignment as follows. This page is

also available in Presentation Styles dialog and Graphics Styles dialog.

Left – aligns the paragraph to the left page margin. If Asian language support is enabled, this option is named Left/Top.

Right – aligns the paragraph to the right page margin. If Asian language support is enabled, this option is named Right/Bottom.

Centered – centers the contents of the paragraph on the page.

Justify – aligns the paragraph to the left and to the right page margins.

Text direction – specifies the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout

(CTL) and is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.

The paragraph alignment options can also be accessed using the paragraph alignment icons

on the Text Formatting toolbar (Figure 42).

Figure 50: Alignment in Paragraph dialog

Tabs

Use the Tabs page (Figure 51) to determine the tab stops. This page is also available in

Presentation Styles dialog and Graphics Styles dialog.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 67

Figure 51: Tabs in Paragraph dialog

Creating tabs

1) Set the size of the tab stop in the Position text box.

2) Select the type of tab in Type. If you set the type to Decimal, specify the character to be used as the decimal point In Character box.

Left – aligns the left edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the right.

The name of this tab stop is Left/Top if Asian language support is enabled.

Right – aligns the right edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the left of the tab stop. This name of this tab stop is Right/Bottom if Asian language support is enabled.

Center – aligns the center of the text to the tab stop.

Decimal – aligns the decimal point of a number to the center of the tab stop and text to the left of the tab.

Character – enter a character that you want the decimal tab to use as a decimal separator.

3) Select a Fill character which will be drawn from the tab insertion point up to the tab stop.

None – inserts no fill characters and removes any existing fill characters to the left of the tab stop.

....... – fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dots.

------ – fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dashes.

______ – draws a line to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.

Character – specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.

4) Click the New button to apply the new tab stop to the current paragraph.

5) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

68 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Editing tabs

1) Select the tab you want to edit in the Position box.

2) Select the Type and Fill character you want to use.

3) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Note

To change the tab position, you have to delete the tab first, then create a new tab

with the changes you require. Follow the procedures in “Deleting tabs” and “Creating tabs”.

Deleting tabs

1) Select the tab in the Position box.

2) Click Delete to delete the selected tab.

3) Click Delete All to delete all of the tab stops that are set for the current paragraph.

4) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Asian Typography

Use the Asian Typography page (Figure 52) to set the following properties relative to line changes.

This page is also available in Presentation Styles dialog and Graphics Styles dialog.

Apply list of forbidden characters to the beginning and end of lines – prevents the characters in the list from starting or ending a line. The characters are relocated to either the previous line or the next line. To edit the list of restricted characters that start or end a line, go to LibreOffice > Language Settings > Asian Layout.

Allow hanging punctuation – prevents commas and periods from breaking the line. Instead, these characters are added to the end of the line, even in the page margin.

Apply spacing between Asian, Latin and Complex text – inserts a space between Asian,

Latin and complex characters.

Figure 52: Asian Typography in Paragraph dialog

Creating bulleted and numbered lists

The procedure to create a bulleted or numbered list varies depending on the type of text box used, although the tools to manage the list and customize the appearance are the same. In AutoLayout text boxes created automatically by Impress, the outline styles available are, by default, bulleted lists. For normal text boxes an additional step is required to create a bulleted list.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 69

Creating lists in AutoLayout text boxes

Every text box included in the available layouts is already formatted as a bulleted list, therefore to create a bulleted list the only necessary steps are as follows:

1) From the Layout pane, choose a slide design that contains a text box. Those are easily recognizable from the thumbnail.

2) Click on the text ●Click to add text in the text box and start typing your first item.

3) Press Enter to start a new bulleted line.

4) Press Shift+Enter to start a new line without creating a new bullet or number. The new line will have the same indentation as the previous line.

5) Press Tab, or the Demote icon

on the Text Formatting toolbar (Figure 42), or use the

keyboard shortcut Alt+Shift+Right to demote or move your item down to the next outline level.

6) Press Shift+Tab, or the Promote icon on the Text Formatting toolbar, or use the keyboard shortcut Alt+Shift+Left to promote or move your item up to the next outline level.

7) Click the Bullets On/Off icon on the Text Formatting toolbar to create a list without bullet points or an item without a bullet point.

By default, the list created is a bulleted list. To customize the list appearance or to change from

bulleted to numbered or numbered to bulleted, refer to “Changing list appearance” below.

In AutoLayout text boxes, promoting or demoting an item in the list corresponds to applying a different outline style. This means that the second outline level corresponds to Outline 2 style, the third to Outline 3 style and so on. As a consequence, a change in the level also produces other changes (for example font size, bullet type, and so on).

Caution

Do not try to change the outline level by selecting the text and then clicking the desired outline style as you would in Writer. Due to the way that presentation styles work in Impress it is not possible to apply outline levels in this way.

Creating lists in other text boxes

To create a list in a text box, follow these steps:

1) Place the cursor in the text box.

2) Click the Bullets On/Off icon in the Text Formatting toolbar

(Figure 42).

3) Type the text and press Enter to start a new bulleted line.

4) Press Shift+Enter to start a new line without creating a new bullet or number. The new line will have the same indentation as the previous line.

5) Press Tab to increase the indent level of your item.

6) Press Shift+Tab to decrease the indent level of your item.

To customize the list appearance or to change from bulleted to numbered or numbered to bulleted,

refer to “Changing list appearance” below.

Changing list appearance

You can fully customize the appearance of a list, change the bullet type or numbering for the entire list or for a single entry. All the changes can be made using the Bullets and Numbering dialog

(Figure 53), which is accessed by selecting Format > Bullets and Numbering on the main menu

bar or by clicking on the Bullets and Numbering icon on the Text Formatting toolbar.

70 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 53: Bullets and Numbering dialog – Bullets page

Selecting entries

To change the appearance of an entire list:

1) Select the entire list by highlighting all the text in the text box or click on the border of the text box so that the selection handles are displayed.

2) Select Format > Bullets and Numbering on the main menu bar or click on the Bullets

and Numbering icon on the Text Formatting toolbar to open the Bullets and

Numbering dialog (Figure 53). This dialog contains five pages: Bullets, Numbering type,

Graphics, Position, and Customize.

3) If a bulleted list is required, select the bullet style from the default styles available on the

Bullets page.

4) If a numbered list is needed, select a numbering style from the default numbering styles on the Numbering type page.

5) If a graphics style is needed, select a graphic style from the default styles available on the

Graphics page.

6) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

To change the appearance of a single item in a list, click anywhere in the line to place the cursor in the line and the follow steps 2 through to 5 above.

If the list was created in an AutoLayout text box, then an alternative way to change the entire list is to modify the Outline styles. Changes made to the outline style will apply to all the slides using them, so be careful before using this command. The pages related to list management are described below.

Position page

Use the Position page (Figure 54) to adjust the indentation and spacing of the bullet point and its

text. This page is particularly effective when used in combination with the Customize page.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 71

Figure 54: Bullets and Numbering – Position page

Set up an outline level as follows:

1) Select the level from the list on the left hand side of the page. Select level 1 – 10 to modify all levels simultaneously.

2) Set the Indent value to create spacing between the bullet or number and the text. If level

1 – 10 is selected, Indent is not available.

3) Select the Relative option to measure the indent value relative to the previous level and not from the margin.

4) Set Width of numbering to make sure there is enough room in a numbered list for numbers when they consist of two or more digits.

5) Set Numbering alignment to specify the alignment of numbers when creating a numbered list. For example, you may want to align numbers to the right when your numbered list includes numbers with two or more digits.

6) Click Default to set indent and spacing values to the Impress default values.

7) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Note

The Position page is not available if you are modifying a presentation style or graphics style. However, the same effects can be obtained using the Indents and

Spacing page of the Paragraph dialog (Figure 49 on page 66) for creating or

modifying a slide.

Customize page

Use the Customize page (Figure 55) to alter the style of outline levels. The options available on

this page depend on the type of marker selected for the list. Using the Customize page, you can create complex structured layouts, for example a nested list with numbering followed by bullets.

72 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 55: Bullets and Numbering – Customize page

1) To modify each level independently, select each level you want to modify on the left hand side of the box. The right hand side of the screen shows a preview of the modifications made.

2) To modify all levels at once, select 1 – 10 as the level. With these levels being arranged in a hierarchical structure, changing, for example, the font attribute of one of the levels ripples through all the lower levels.

3) Select the options you want to use when customizing your list. The options available are described below.

4) To revert to the default values used in Impress, click Reset.

5) When you have finished customizing your list, click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Depending on the bullet or numbering style selected, some of the following options may not be available on the Customize page:

Numbering – select the type of numbering you want to use in your list from the drop down list.

Before – enter any text or characters to appear before the number (for example, Step).

After – enter any text or characters to appear after the number (for example, a punctuation mark).

Color – select the color for the list marker (number or bullet character) from the drop down list.

Relative size – specify the size of the number relative to the size of the characters used in the paragraph for each item.

Start at – enter the first value of the list (for example, you might want the list to start at 4 instead of 1).

Character button – select a special character for the bullet.

Graphics – select a graphic from the gallery of available graphics or a file on to be used as a marker.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 73

Width – specifies the width of the graphic used as a marker.

Height – specifies the height of the graphic used as a marker.

Keep ratio – if selected, the ratio between the width and the height of the graphic marker is maintained.

Using tables

Tables are a powerful mechanism to convey structured information quickly, so they represent an important tool when creating a presentation. You can create tables directly in Impress eliminating the need to embed a Calc spreadsheet or a Writer text table in your presentation. However, in some circumstances, it makes sense to embed a Calc spreadsheet, especially when you require greater functionality in the table. The tables provided by Impress do have a limited functionality.

Many predefined table designs are available in the Table Design section of the Tasks pane (Figure

56).

Figure 56: Table Design section

74

Figure 57: Insert Table dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Creating a table

When working with tables, it is useful to know the number of rows and columns needed as well as the appearance. The parameters can be adjusted later, but this is more laborious than setting the correct table dimensions from the beginning.

Using Table Design

To insert a table using the Table Design section in the Tasks pane, proceed as follows:

1) Select the slide which will contain the table and, if necessary, modify the slide layout to create space for the table.

2) Select Table Design (Figure 56) in the Tasks pane. If the Tasks pane is not visible, select

View > Task pane.

3) Select one of the predefined styles, which only differ in the color scheme. It is recommended that you select a color scheme similar to the one you want, but you can change table colors later on.

4) Specify the number of columns and number of rows in the Insert Table dialog (Figure 57).

5) Click OK to close the dialog and your table appears in the center of your slide.

6) Move the table by selecting it and dragging it to a new position, or use the method

described in “Position and size” on page 79.

Creating a table directly

To create a table directly, proceed as follows:

1) Select Insert > Table on the main menu bar or click the Table icon on the Standard

toolbar to open the Insert Table dialog (Figure 57).

Figure 58: Table graphic insert tool

2) Specify the number of columns and rows.

3) Click OK to close the dialog and your table appears in the center of your slide.

4) Alternatively, click on the small triangle to the right of the Table icon to open a graphic tool

for inserting a table (Figure 58).

5) Drag the mouse cursor to the right and down in the grid until you have the required number of columns and rows

6) Click the left mouse button to insert the table into your slide.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 75

Note

Using either Insert > Table, Table icon, or the graphic tool for inserting tables inserts a table with the default style and settings already applied. This table can be modified to your requirements.

When tables are inserted into a slide, they are given a set of default attributes such as color scheme, banded rows, header row and so on. Currently these defaults are hard coded in LibreOffice and cannot be changed.

Modifying a table

Once the table is added to the slide, you can control its appearance, size, position and so on using a combination of the Tasks pane options, the Table toolbar and the Table properties dialog.

Tasks pane options

The following options are available in the Show section of Table Design on the Tasks pane:

Header Row – selected by default and adds a first row with a different background from the rest of the table.

Total Row – the opposite of Header Row. If selected, it changes the background of the last row to make it stand out from the other rows.

Banded Rows – selected by default and option colors alternate rows with different backgrounds making it easier to read data presented in rows.

First Column – highlights the first column of the table by allocating a darker background to it.

Last Column – highlights the last column of the table by allocating a darker background to it.

Banded Columns – when selected, alternate columns are colored differently.

Table toolbar

When a table is selected, eight selection handles appear around the edges and the Table toolbar

(Figure 59) is displayed. If the Table toolbar is not displayed when a table is selected, go to View >

Toolbars > Table on the main menu bar. The Table toolbar contains the majority of the tools you need to modify a table.

Table

Creates a new table in the selected slide. Opens the Insert Table dialog (Figure 57) where you

can select the required number of rows and columns. Alternatively, click on the small triangle to

the right of the Table icon to open a graphic tool for inserting tables (Figure 58). See “Creating a table directly” on page 75 for more information on inserting tables into your slide.

Line Style

Changes the style of the line of the selected cells. Opens a Border Style drop-down list where you can select from a range of predefined line styles.

Line Color (of the border)

Opens a Border Color drop-down menu where you can select the color of the borders around the selected cells.

Borders

Opens a Borders drop-down menu where you can select a predefined border configuration for the selected cells. If the desired border pattern is not available, you will need to use the Table properties dialog.

76 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 59: Table Toolbar

Area Style/Filling

In the drop-down menu, select how the selected cells should be filled: Invisible, Color,

Gradient, Hatching, or Bitmap. Depending on the selection, the drop-down menu lists the available fillings for the option selected. Refer to Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects for details on how to manage area filling styles.

Merge Cells

Merges the selected cells into one cell. Note that the contents of the merged cells are also merged. You can also right-click on the selected cells and select Cell > Merge from the context menu.

Split Cells

Make sure that the cursor is positioned on the cell you want to split, then click to open the Split

Cells dialog (Figure 60). Select the number of cells required from the split as well as whether

the cell should be split horizontally or vertically. When splitting horizontally, you can select the

Into equal proportions option to get all cells of equal size. The contents of the split cell are kept in the original cell (the one on the left or top). You can also right-click on the selected cells and select Cell > Split from the context menu.

Optimize

Evenly distributes the selected cells either horizontally or vertically. You can also right-click in the selected cells and select Row > Space Equally or Column > Space Equally from the context menu. If you want to optimize the whole table, you can evenly distribute rows or columns by right-clicking on the table border and select Row > Space Equally or Column >

Space Equally from the context menu.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 77

Figure 60: Split Cells dialog

Top, Center (vertical), Bottom

You can select the vertical alignment of text in a cell by selecting the required cells and choosing the appropriate alignment. You can also right-click in the selected cells, then select

Cell from the context menu and choose the appropriate alignment. To apply cell alignment to the whole table, right-click on the table border, then select Cell from the context menu and choose the appropriate alignment.

Insert Row, Insert Column

Clicking on Insert Row or Insert Column inserts a single row or column below and to the right of the selected cell. To insert more than one row or column, highlight cells across the number of rows or columns required, then click on Insert Row or Insert Column. You can also right-click in the selected cells and select Row > Insert or Column > Insert from the context menu.

Select the required number of rows or columns in the dialog that opens and click OK.

To insert rows at the beginning of the table and columns at the left of the table, select the table, then right-click on the table border. Select the required number of rows or columns in the dialog that opens and click OK.

Delete Row, Delete Column

Clicking on Delete Row or Delete Column deletes a single row or column below where you have selected a cell. To delete more than one row or column, highlight cells across the number of rows or columns required, then click on Delete Row or Delete Column. You can also rightclick in the selected cells and select Row > Delete or Column > Delete from the context menu.

Select Table, Select Column, Select Rows

These three icons select the complete table or the columns or rows where you have selected cells. By default these icons are not displayed on the Table toolbar. To display these icons, right-click in a blank area on the toolbar and select Visible Buttons from the context menu.

Click on the icon you want displayed in the toolbar.

Table Design

Opens the Table Design section in the Tasks pane.

Table Properties

Click the Table Properties icon on the Table toolbar, or right-click in the table and select Table

from the context menu to open the Format Cells dialog (Figure 61), which contains the

following pages.

Font – use to select the desired font type, its base attributes (Italic, Bold, etc.) as well as the size. A sample of the font is displayed in the lower part of the dialog. You can also

specify the language. See “Font page” on page 63 for more information on the available

options.

78 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Font Effects – use to apply special effects to the text, such as over lining and underlining, color, shadow and so on. A sample of the text is displayed in the lower part of the dialog,

providing a quick visual check of the effects applied. See “Font Effects page” on page 63

for more information on the available options.

Borders – use to set advanced properties not available when using the Table toolbar, such as the spacing between the text and the border as well as setting the style of each individual border of the table separately. This page also provides the same options as the

Line Style and Line Color on the Table toolbar.

Note

It is currently not possible to define diagonal borders for Impress tables.

Background: changes the background of the selected cells and provides the same functions as Area Style/Filling on the Table toolbar.

Figure 61: Format Cells dialog

Position and size

Impress treats tables just like any other graphic object. You can change table position and size on the slide by using the selection handles and the mouse.

For more accurate control with positioning and table sizing, open the Position and Size dialog

(Figure 62). With the table is selected, right-click on the border of table and select Position and

Size from the context menu or go to Format > Position and Size on the main menu bar, or press the F4 key. Only the Position and Size page in this dialog can be used for tables. For more information on this dialog see Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects.

Deleting tables

To delete a table use one of the following methods:

Click in the slide and drag a selection box over the table to select it, then press the delete key.

Select all the rows in the table and click Delete Row on the Table toolbar, or right-click and select Row > Delete from the context menu.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 79

Figure 62: Position and Size dialog

Using fields

Fields allow the automatic insertion of text into the slide. You can think of a field as a kind of formula which is calculated when the document is loaded or printed and the result is written in the document. Fields are commonly used when creating templates and slide masters, as explained in

Chapter 2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates.

Inserting a field

To insert a field into a slide, select the slide where the field will be and then select Insert > Fields on the main menu bar followed by one of these options:

Date (fixed) – inserts the current date into your slide as a fixed field. The date is not automatically updated.

Date (variable) – inserts the current date into your slide as a variable field. The date is automatically updated when you open the file.

Time (fixed) – inserts the current time into your slide as a fixed field. The time is not automatically updated.

Time (variable) – inserts the current time into your slide as a variable field. The time is automatically updated when you open the file.

Author – inserts the first and last names of the author of the presentation. This information is derived from the value recorded in the LibreOffice user data. To modify this information go to Tools > Options > LibreOffice > User Data.

Page Number – inserts the page number into the current slide. If you want to add a page number to every slide, go to View > Master > Slide Master on the main menu bar and insert the page number field.

Page Count – inserts the total number of slides.

File Name – inserts the name of the file. The file name only appears after you save the file.

80 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Formatting fields

Date and time fields

To format a date or time field:

1) Right-click on the field.

2) Select the desired format from the context menu that opens. The available formats will depend on the language setting in Tools > Options > Language Settings > Language.

Page number fields

Formatting the page number fields can be done one of two ways:

Select the page number field and apply the formatting manually.

Go to Format > Page on the main menu bar and select a format from the list in Layout

Settings in the Page Setup dialog.

Using hyperlinks

When inserting text (such as a website address or URL) that can be used as a hyperlink, Impress formats it automatically, creating the hyperlink and applying color and underlining. If you do not want Impress to use its default settings, then you have to insert a hyperlink manually.

Tips

To prevent LibreOffice from automatically turning website addresses (URLs) into hyperlinks, go to Tools > AutoCorrect > Options and deselect the URL Recognition checkbox.

To change the color of hyperlinks, go to Tools > Options > LibreOffice >

Appearance, scroll to Unvisited links and/or Visited links, select the checkboxes, select new colors and click OK. Note that this will change the color for all hyperlinks in all components of LibreOffice which may not be what you want.

Inserting hyperlinks

To insert a hyperlink, or customize the appearance of a hyperlink

1) Select Insert > Hyperlinks on the main menu bar to open the Hyperlink dialog (Figure 63).

2) On the left hand side, select one of the four types of hyperlinks. The top right part of the dialog changes according to the selection of hyperlink type. A full description of all the choices, and their interactions, is beyond the scope of this chapter. A summary of the most common choices used in a presentation are given below.

3) Create your hyperlink using the dialog, then click Apply to insert into your slide.

4) Click Close to close the dialog.

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 81

Figure 63: Hyperlink dialog

The options for Hyperlink type available are as follows:

Internet – choose whether the link is Web or FTP. Enter the required web address in the

Target text box.

Mail & News – choose whether the link is an E-mail or news link. Enter the details of the

Recipient and the Subject.

Document – creates a hyperlink to another document or to another place in a document, commonly referred to as a bookmark.

Enter the Path details in the text box, or click the Open File icon to open a file browser. Leave this blank if you want to link to a target in the same presentation.

Optionally, you can specify a target (for example a specific slide). Click on the Target in

Document icon to open a dialog where you can select the target., If you know the name of the target, you can type it into the Target text box.

New Document: – creates a hyperlink to a new document. Select whether to edit the newly created document immediately (Edit now) or just create it to edit later (Edit later). Choose the type of document to create (text, spreadsheet, etc.). The Select path icon opens a file browser so that you can choose the directory for the new document.

Note

For navigation within a presentation, it is generally better to use the object interaction menu that you can find either in the Drawing toolbar or in the context menu that opens when right-clicking on an object.

The Further settings section on the Hyperlink dialog is common to all the hyperlink types, although some choices are more relevant to some types of links.

Frame – set the value to determine how the hyperlink will open. This applies to documents that open in a web browser.

Form – specifies if the link is to be presented as text or as a button. See “Working with hyperlink buttons” on page 83 for more information.

Text – specifies the text that will be visible to the user.

Name – applicable to HTML documents. It specifies text that will be added as a NAME attribute in the HTML code behind the hyperlink.

82 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Formatting hyperlinks

To format a hyperlink:

1) Select it by dragging a selection across the text. Do not click on the hyperlink because this will open the hyperlink.

2) Right-click on the selected hyperlink.

3) Select the type of formatting you want to change from the options available in the context menu.

Working with hyperlink buttons

A hyperlink button is inserted in the center of the current slide. In most cases, that is not where you want it to appear. To edit the text or size of a hyperlink button, or to move it to another place on the slide:

1) Go to View > Toolbars > Form Controls on the main menu bar to open the Form Controls

toolbar (Figure 64).

2) Click the Design Mode On/Off icon . All the icons on the Form Controls toolbar become active.

3) Select the hyperlink button you want to edit or move.

4) Drag the hyperlink button to another position, or right-click to open a context menu where you can change the text on the button, the size of the button, and other properties.

5) When you have finished editing the button, click the Design Mode On/Off icon again to make the icons inactive. For a detailed description of the properties and how to work with

Form Controls, refer to the Writer Guide.

Figure 64: Form Controls toolbar

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text 83

Chapter

4

Adding and Formatting

Pictures

Introduction

Pictures are often used in presentations as they can convey a large amount of information more quickly than the written word. You can also give a more professional look to your presentation by adding a company logo. Also, you may want to use Impress to create a presentation consisting only of pictures, such as a slideshow of holiday snapshots to share with friends.

This chapter describes how to insert and format pictures.

Inserting pictures

This section describes several ways to insert a picture from an external source into the presentation. Once the picture has been inserted, it can be formatted extensively.

Inserting a picture from a file

Inserting a picture from a file is quick and easy. First choose a slide layout, as described in

Chapter 1 Introducing Impress. Most layouts include a set of icons for inserting objects, but you can insert a picture into any slide.

Whether you are using an AutoLayout for the placement of the picture, or you are just inserting a picture, follow these steps:

1) Go to Insert > Picture > From file on the menu bar or click on the Insert Picture icon

(Figure 65) if you have inserted a slide and the Insert Picture dialog opens (Figure 66).

2) Navigate to the directory containing the desired picture and select the file. LibreOffice recognizes a large number of image types. If the Preview option is selected, a thumbnail of the selected file will be displayed in the preview pane on the right.

3) Click Open to place the picture on the current slide. The picture is now displayed on the slide with selection handles displayed around the picture border.

86

Figure 65: Slide showing the placeholder for inserting objects

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 66: Insert Picture dialog

Note

The Insert Picture dialog has two options: Link and Preview. The position of these options is determined by the operating system, but they are normally in the bottomleft part of the dialog.

Select the Link option to insert the picture as a link to a file rather than embedding the file itself. In general it is preferable to embed images so that the presentation can be copied for use on other computers. On some occasions, however, it makes sense to link the image rather than embed it.

These include:

When the image file is quite large and linking rather than embedding will dramatically reduce the size of the presentation file.

When the same image file is used in many presentations. For example, when using the same background image for all the presentations created.

When the linked file will be available when loading the presentation. For example, if the presentation is a slide show of holiday pictures.

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 87

Inserting a picture from a scanner

Inserting an image from a scanner is normally a simple process if one or more than one of the following are valid.

The scanner software driver has been installed on the computer.

The scanner is supported by the SANE system if the computer operating system is Linux or other UNIX-like operating system

The scanner is TWAIN compatible and the computer is operating Windows or Mac OS.

The scanner is configured on the computer with LibreOffice software installed.

The following scanning procedure is only an example to demonstrate how to insert a picture from a scanner. The actual procedure you use on your computer will depend on the operating system, the type of scanner being used and the scanner driver software installed.

1) Prepare the image for the scanner and make sure that the scanner is switched on.

2) Go to Insert > Picture > Scan > Select Source on the main menu bar to open the

Scanner dialog (Figure 67). If you have previously used your scanner, then go to Insert >

Picture > Scan > Request on the main menu bar to open the Scanner dialog.

3) If you have more than one scanner connected, select the scanner from the Select Source or Device Used drop-down list.

4) If available, click Create Preview or Preview to carry out a preview scan of the picture and place it in the preview area.

5) If necessary crop the scanned image to what you require and make any necessary scanning adjustments.

6) Click Scan and, when the image has been scanned, Impress places it into the selected slide. At this point it can be edited as any other image using the available Impress tools.

88

Figure 67: Example of a Scanner dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Inserting a picture from the Gallery

The Gallery contains a collection of images that you can use in a presentation. You can also add your own images to the Gallery, making it an essential tool for creating presentations quickly and with a consistent look. The Gallery is available in all components of LibreOffice. For an introduction to the Gallery, see the Getting Started Guide Chapter 11 Graphics, the Gallery, and Fontwork.

1) Go to Tools > Gallery on the main menu bar or click the Gallery icon on the Drawing

toolbar to open the Gallery dialog (Figure 68). The Gallery displays the available themes

with images that are available for each theme.

2) Select a theme from the left pane and then scroll through the right pane to find a suitable image.

3) Click on the image and drag it onto the workspace.

4) Release the mouse button and the image will be placed into your slide. If necessary, resize

the image as described in “Resizing pictures” on page 92.

Figure 68. Inserting an image from the Gallery

Positioning the Gallery

To expand the Gallery, position the cursor over the line that divides it from the top of the workspace. When the cursor changes shape, click and drag downward. The workspace will resize in response.

By default, the Gallery is docked above the Impress workspace. To undock it, hold down the Ctrl key and double-click on the upper part of the Gallery next to the View icons. Double-click in the same area again to dock it in its default position at the top of the workspace.

When the Gallery is docked, to hide it and view the full Impress workspace, click the Hide/Show

button in the middle of the thin bar separating the Gallery from the workspace (highlighted in Figure

68). The Hide/Show button lets you keep the Gallery open for quick access while you create your

slide show, yet out of the way when you are no longer using the Gallery.

Managing Gallery themes

Graphics in the Gallery are grouped by themes, such as Bullets, Rulers, and 3D Effects. The left pane of the gallery window lists the available themes. Click on a theme to see its images displayed in the right pane of the Gallery dialog.

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 89

The default themes are read only; no images or graphics can be added to or deleted from these themes. The default themes are easily recognizable by right-clicking on each category and the only available option in the pop-up menu is Properties.

In a default installation of LibreOffice, My Theme is the only category that is customizable and allows you add or delete your own images. You can also create new theme categories where you

can add or delete your own images, as explained in “Creating new themes” on page 91.

Adding images to My Themes

You can only add images to My Theme or themes that you have created.

1) Right-click on My Theme or the theme name that you created in the list of themes and select Properties from the context menu to open the Properties of My Theme dialog

(Figure 69).

2) Click on the Files tab.

3) Click Find Files to open the Select Path dialog.

4) Browse to the folder that contains the images you want to use.

5) Click OK to select the files contained in the folder and the Select Path dialog closes. The list of files contained in the folder now appear in the Properties of My Theme dialog.

6) Select the files you want to use in My Theme and click Add. The added files will disappear from the file list and the images will appear in the Gallery.

7) If you want to add all the files in the list, then click Add All. All the files will disappear from the list and the images will appear in the Gallery.

8) Click OK when finished and the Properties of My Theme dialog will close.

90

Figure 69. Properties of My Theme dialog – Files page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Deleting images from the Gallery

You can only delete images from My Theme or themes that you have created.

1) Open the Gallery and select My Theme or a theme that you created.

2) Right-click on the image in the Gallery window.

3) Select Delete from the context menu.

4) A confirmation message appears, asking if you want to delete this object. Click Yes.

Note

An images are linked files and are deleted from the Gallery only. The original image files are not deleted.

Updating themes

All the images in the Gallery are linked files. You may wish to update a theme occasionally, to make sure that all the files are still there.

1) Open the Gallery.

2) Right-click on the theme where you added at least one file.

3) Select Update from the context menu.

Creating new themes

To add a new theme to the list of themes in the Gallery:

1) Open the Gallery.

2) Click New Theme above the list of themes and the Properties of New Theme dialog opens

(Figure 70).

3) Click the General tab and type a name for the new theme in the text box.

4) Click the Files tab and follow the procedure in “Adding images to My Themes” on page 90.

5) The new theme will now be displayed in the list of themes in the Gallery.

Figure 70. Creating a new theme

Note

If you wish, you can rename a new theme by right-clicking on the theme name and selecting Rename from the context menu.

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 91

Formatting pictures

Moving pictures

1) Click on a picture to select it. Selection handles are displayed.

2) Move the cursor over the picture until it changes shape. The cursor shape depends on the computer operating system, for example a four headed arrow or a hand.

3) Click and drag the picture to the desired position.

4) Release the mouse button.

For a more accurate placement of a picture, use the Position and Size dialog described in Chapter

6 Formatting Graphic Objects.

Resizing pictures

1) Click on a picture to show the selection handles.

2) Position the cursor over one of the selection handles. The cursor changes shape giving a graphical representation of the direction of the resizing.

3) Click and drag to resize the picture.

4) Release the mouse button when satisfied with the new size.

For more accurate resizing of a picture, use the Position and Size dialog described in Chapter 6

Formatting Graphic Objects.

Note

The corner selection handles resize both the width and the height of the graphic object simultaneously, while the other four selection handles only resize one dimension at a time.

Tip

To retain the original proportions of the graphic, Shift+click one of the corner selection handles and then drag. Make sure to release the mouse button before releasing the

Shift key.

Caution

Be aware that re-sizing a bit-mapped (raster) image will adversely affect the resolution causing some degree of blurring. It is better to use a specialized graphics program to correctly scale the picture to the desired size before inserting it into your presentation.

LibreOffice recommend you use a tool such as Gimp ( http://www.gimp.org/ ).

Rotating pictures

As with the position of the image on the page, rotation of a picture can be done manually or using a dedicated dialog. The Rotation dialog is described in Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects.

Rotate a picture manually as follows:

1) Select the picture to display the selection handles.

2) Click the Rotate icon on the Line and Filling toolbar or click again on the selected

picture and the selection handles change color (Figure 71). The color change will depend

on the computer operating system and how the computer has been setup.

92 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 71: Rotating pictures

Note

The icons representing the functions in the toolbars depend on the computer operating system used and how the computer has been setup, or whether LibreOffice has been customized or not. When in doubt, hover the mouse over the icons and wait for the tooltip to appear showing the name of the button.

3) A circle or circle with crosshairs (depending on computer system) appears in the center of the picture indicating the rotation point. The center of the picture is the normal rotation point, but this rotation point can be moved to change the rotation center to a corner or to a point outside the picture. To do this, click on the rotation point and drag it to the desired position before applying the rotation.

4) The selection handles in each corner are the rotation handles and the cursor shape will change when moved over one of them. Click the mouse and move in the direction in which you want to rotate the picture.

5) When satisfied, release the mouse button.

Tip

To restrict the rotation angles to multiples of 15 degrees, press the Shift key while rotating the graphic. This is very handy to rotate pictures of right angles, for example from portrait to landscape or from landscape to portrait.

Formatting using the Picture toolbar

When a picture is selected, the Picture toolbar becomes available. This toolbar provides a number of formatting options which are described in this section. If the picture toolbar does not appear when an image is selected, display it by selecting View > Toolbars > Picture from the menu bar

(Figure 72).

Figure 72: Picture toolbar

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 93

Table 2: Graphic filters and their effects

Icon Name Effect

Invert

Inverts the color values of a color image, or the brightness values of a grayscale image. Apply the filter again to revert the effect.

Smooth Softens or blurs the image by applying a low pass filter.

Sharpen

Remove noise

Solarization

Aging

Posterize

Pop Art

Charcoal sketch

Relief

Mosaic

Sharpens the image by applying a high pass filter.

Removes noise by applying a median filter.

Opens a dialog for defining solarization. Solarization refers to an effect that looks like what can happen when there is too much light during photo development. The colors become partly inverted.

Parameters – specifies the degree and type of solarization.

Threshold Value – specifies the degree of brightness, in percent, above which the pixels are to be solarized.

Invert – specifies to also invert all pixels.

All pixels are set to their gray values, and then the green and blue color channels are reduced by the amount you specify. The red color channel is not changed.

Aging Degree – defines the intensity of aging, in percent. At 0% you see the gray values of all pixels. At 100% only the red color channel remains.

Opens a dialog to determine the number of poster colors. This effect is based on the reduction of the number of colors. It makes photos look like paintings.

Poster Colors – specifies the number of colors to which the image is to be reduced.

Converts an image to a pop-art format.

Displays the image as a charcoal sketch. The contours of the image are drawn in black, and the original colors are suppressed.

Displays a dialog for creating reliefs. You can choose the position of the imaginary light source that determines the type of shadow created, and how the graphic image looks in relief.

Light Source – specifies the light source position. A dot represents the light source.

Joins small groups of pixels into rectangular areas of the same color. The larger the individual rectangles are, the fewer details the graphic image has.

Width – defines the width of the individual tiles.

Height – defines the height of the individual tiles.

Enhance edges – enhances, or sharpens, the edges of the object.

94 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Applying filters

The graphic filters available on the Picture toolbar apply various filters to the selected picture. The

best way to judge if a filter works for your picture is to try it. Table 2 describes briefly each of the

available graphic filters and their effects. See the Draw Guide for more information and examples of the effects.

1) Select the pictures so that the selection handles are displayed and the Picture toolbar becomes available.

2) Click on the Filter icon to show the different graphic filters that are available.

3) Select the filter you wish to apply. To show the name of the filter, hover the cursor over the icon and wait for the tooltip to appear.

4) If you are not satisfied with the effect obtained or you want to try a different filter and before doing anything else, click the Undo icon on the Standard toolbar or select Edit >

Undo: Bitmap Graphic Filter on the main menu bar or use the keyboard combination

Ctrl+Z.

Changing graphics mode

Click on Graphics mode on the Picture toolbar (Figure 72) to open a drop-down list and change

the graphic mode using one of the following options.

Default – the view of the graphic object is not changed.

Grayscale – the graphic object is shown in grayscale. A color graphic object can become monochrome in grayscale. You can also use the color sliders to apply a uniform color to a monochrome graphic object.

Black/White – the graphic object is shown in black and white. All brightness values below

50% will appear black, all brightness values over 50% will appear white.

Watermark – the graphic object is raised in brightness and reduced in contrast so that it can be used in the background as a watermark.

Adjusting color

Clicking on the Color icon

in the Picture toolbar (Figure 72) opens the Color dialog (Figure

73). Use this dialog to modify the individual color components of the image (red, green, blue) as

well as the brightness, contrast, and gamma of the image. Increasing the gamma value of a picture makes it more suitable to be used as a background or watermark as it will interfere less with a dark text.

Figure 73: Color dialog

To adjust colors more accurately, delete, edit or add colors. go to Format > Area on the main

menu bar to open the Area dialog, then click on the Colors tab (Figure 74). This dialog page

provides the following options when working with color.

Name – specifies the name of a selected color. You can also type a name in this field when defining a new color.

Color – contains a list of available colors. To select a color, choose one from the list.

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 95

Figure 74. Colors page in Area dialog

Color table – to modify colors, select the color model: Red-Green-Blue (RGB) or Cyan-

Magenta-Yellow-BlacK (CMYK). LibreOffice uses only the RGB color model for printing in color. The CMYK controls are provided only to ease the input of color values using CMYK notation.

If you select RGB, the initials of the three colors will appear and you can set the color from

0 to 255 with the spin button.

If you select CMYK, the initials of the four colors will appear and you can set the color from

0 to 255 with the spin button.

Add – adds a new color.

Modify – changes the current color. Note that the color is overwritten without a confirmation.

Edit – define your own colors using the two-dimensional graphic and numerical gradient chart.

Delete – deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.

Load Color List – this icon opens a file dialog, which allows you to select a color palette.

Save Color List – this icon opens the Save As dialog, which enables you to save the current color table under a specified name. If you do not choose this command, the current color table will be automatically saved as default and re-loaded the next time you start

LibreOffice.

The preview boxes display the selected color and the new color you are creating.

Setting object transparency

Click on the Transparency icon on the Picture toolbar (Figure 72) to modify the percentage

value and make the image more transparent. As with the gamma value, increasing the transparency of a picture makes the picture blend more smoothly in the background making the overlay text easier to read.

96 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 75. Transparency page in Area dialog

To adjust the transparency settings applied to a picture, go to Format > Area on the main menu

bar to open the Area dialog, then click on the Transparency tab (Figure 75).

No transparency – turns off color transparency. This is the default setting.

Transparency – turns on color transparency. Select this option and then enter a percentage in the box where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.

Gradient – applies a transparency gradient to the current fill color. Select this option, and then set the gradient properties.

Type – select the type of transparency gradient that you want to apply from Linear, Axial,

Radial, Ellipsoid. Quadratic, or Square.

Center X – enter the horizontal offset for the gradient.

Center Y – enter the vertical offset for the gradient.

Angle – enter a rotation angle for the gradient.

Border – enter the amount by which you want to adjust the transparent area of the gradient. The default value is 0%.

Start value – enter a transparency value for the beginning point of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.

End value – enter a transparency value for the endpoint of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.

Use the preview box to view your changes before you apply the transparency effect to the color fill of the selected object.

Adjusting shadow settings

Click on the Shadow icon on the Picture toolbar (Figure 72) to apply a shadow to the image. If a

shadow is already applied to the picture, clicking on the Shadow icon will remove the shadow.

To adjust the shadow settings applied to a picture, go to Format > Area on the main menu bar to

open the Area dialog, then click on the Shadow tab (Figure 76).

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 97

Figure 76. Shadow page in Area dialog

Position – click where you want to cast the shadow.

Distance – enter the distance that you want the shadow to be offset from the selected object.

Color – select a color for the shadow.

Transparency – enter a percentage from 0% (opaque) to 100% (transparent) to specify the transparency of the shadow.

Use the preview box to view your changes before you apply the shadow effect to the selected object.

Cropping pictures

Impress provides two ways to crop a picture: using a mouse or using a dialog. Using the mouse is easier to use, but the dialog provides more precise control.

To crop a selected picture using the mouse:

1) Select the picture.

2) Click the Crop icon

on the Picture toolbar (Figure 72). A set of crop marks appears

around the picture (Figure 77).

3) Place the cursor over any of the crop marks, the cursor changes shape. Drag the mark to crop the picture.

4) Click outside the picture to deactivate cropping mode.

5) Press and hold the Shift key while working on the crop marks to produce the following effects: a) For a corner mark, the two sides of the picture forming the corner are cropped proportionally with the picture anchored to the opposite corner mark.

b) For a side mark, both dimensions are changed proportionally with the image anchored to the opposite side mark.

98

Figure 77: Cropping pictures using the cursor

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 78: Crop dialog and options available when cropping a picture

To crop a picture using a dialog:

1) Select the picture.

2) Right-click on the picture and select Crop Picture from the context menu or go to Format

> Crop Picture on the main menu bar to open the Crop dialog (Figure 78).

Crop the picture using the options given in the Crop dialog.

3) Click OK when finished to close the dialog.

4) To revert back to the original size of the picture, click Original Size.

The Crop dialog has the following options:

Keep scale – maintains the original scale of the graphic when you crop, so that only the size of the graphic changes.

Keep image size – maintains the original size of the graphic when you crop, so that only the scale of the graphic changes. To reduce the scale of the graphic, select this option and enter negative values in the cropping boxes. To increase the scale of the graphic, enter positive values in the cropping boxes.

Left – if the Keep scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the left edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the left of the graphic. If the Keep

image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.

Right – if the Keep scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the right edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the right of the graphic. If the

Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.

Top – if the Keep scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the top of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space above the graphic. If the Keep image

size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.

Bottom – if the Keep scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the bottom of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space below the graphic. If the Keep image

size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 99

Scale – changes the scale of the selected graphic.

Width – enter the width for the selected graphic as a percentage.

Height – enter the height of the selected graphic as a percentage.

Image size – changes the size of the selected graphic.

Width – enter a width for the selected graphic.

Height – enter a height for the selected graphic.

Original Size – returns the selected graphic to its original size.

Deleting a picture

1) Click on the picture and the selection handles are displayed.

2) Press the Delete key.

Creating an image map

An image map defines areas of the image (called hotspots) associated with a URL (a web address or a file on the computer). Hotspots are the graphic equivalent of text hyperlinks. Clicking on a hotspot causes Impress to open the linked page in the appropriate program (for example, default browser for HTML pages; LibreOffice Writer for .ODT files; PDF viewer for PDF files).

You can create hotspots of various shapes, such as rectangles, ellipses, and polygons. You can also include several hotspots in the same image. When you click on a hotspot, the URL opens in a browser window or frame that you have specified. You can also specify the text that appears when your mouse cursor hovers over the hotspot.

100

Figure 79: Image Map Editor dialog for creating hotspots

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

To use the image map tool to create or edit a hotspot:

1) Select the picture on a slide where hotspots are going to be defined.

2) Go to Edit > ImageMap on the main menu bar and the ImageMap Editor dialog opens

(Figure 79). The main part of the dialog shows the image on which the hotspots will be

defined.

3) Active hotspots are indicated by a colored border, while inactive hotspots are indicated by a black or grayed out border.

4) Use the tools at the top of the dialog and the fields to define hotspots and their links.

5) Click the Apply icon to apply the settings.

6) When done, click the Save icon to save the image map to a file, then close the dialog.

The top part of the dialog, from left to right, contains the following tools:

Apply icon – click this icon to apply any changes made.

Open, Save, and Select icons.

Rectangle, Ellipse, Polygon and FreeForm Polygon icons – drawing tools hotspot shapes. These tools work in exactly the same way as the corresponding tools in the

Drawing toolbar (see Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects).

Edit, Move, Insert, Delete Points icons – advanced editing tools to manipulate the shape of a polygon hotspot. Select Edit Points tool to activate the other tools.

Active icon – toggles the status of the hotspot activating a selected hotspot or deactivating it if active.

Undo and Redo icons.

Macro icon – associates a macro with the hotspot instead of a hyperlink.

Properties icon – sets the hyperlink properties and adds the Name attribute to the hyperlink.

Below the toolbar are fields which specify the properties of a hotspot:

Address – the URL address that points to a hyperlink. You can also point to an anchor in a document such as a specific slide number; to do this, write the address in this format: file:///<path>/document_name#anchor_name

Text – enter the text that will be displayed when the mouse is moved over the hotspot.

Frame – where the target of the hyperlink will open: _blank (opens in a new browser window), _self (default selection and opens in an active browser window), _top or _parent.

Tip

The value _self for the target frame will work on the vast majority of the occasions. It is not recommended to use the other values unless absolutely necessary.

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures 101

Chapter

5

Managing Graphic Objects

Introduction

This chapter describes how to manage graphic objects and in particular how to rotate, distort, arrange, and position them on the slide. Though this chapter focuses on the shapes that can be created with the available tools in Impress, some of the techniques described in this chapter are also applicable to images imported into slides.

Drawing toolbar

Default drawing tools

The Drawing toolbar (Figure 80) contains the majority of the tools normally used to create graphic objects. If this toolbar is not visible, select View > Toolbars > Drawing from the main menu bar.

Table 3 describes the default set of tools that are available on the Drawing toolbar.

Figure 80: Drawing toolbar

Note

Your Drawing toolbar may differ from the one shown in Figure 80 as this depends on

how many drawing tools have been placed on the toolbar. Right-click on an empty area of the Drawing toolbar, then select Visible Buttons from the context menu to display the available tools. From this dialog you can install and remove tools to and from the toolbar. Installed tools are indicated by a border around the icon.

Table 3: Default set of drawing tools on the Drawing toolbar

Tool Name

Select

Line

Line Ends with Arrow

Rectangle

Ellipse

Purpose

Selects objects. To select a group of objects, click above the top left object and drag the mouse below the bottom right object of the intended selection while keeping the mouse button pressed. A “marching ants” rectangle identifying the selection area is displayed. You can also select several objects by pressing and holding the Shift key while selecting the individual objects.

Draws a straight line from the point where you click the mouse to the point where you drag the mouse pointer and release the mouse button. Press the Shift key to restrict the angle of the line to multiples of 45°. Press the

Alt key to draw a line from its center. Press the Ctrl key to detach the end

point of the line from the grid (see “Snapping objects to grid or snap guides” on page 119).

Draws a straight line ending with an arrowhead. The arrowhead is placed at the end of the line where you release the mouse button. The Shift, Alt and Ctrl keys have the same effect as for the Line tool.

Draws a rectangle when you drag the mouse from the top left to the bottom right corner. Press the Shift key to draw a square. Press the Alt key to draw a rectangle or square from its center.

Draws an ellipse. Press the Shift key to draw a circle. Press the Alt key to draw an ellipse or circle from its center.

104 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Tool Name

Text

Purpose

Creates a text box with text aligned horizontally.

Vertical Text Creates a text box with text aligned vertically. This tool is available only when Asian language support has been enabled in Tools > Options >

Language Settings > Languages.

Curve Draws a shape depending on the option that has been selected. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to show the available options Note that the title of this submenu when undocked from the Drawing toolbar is Lines.

Connector Draws a connector line between two figures. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to show the available options. Each option is described in

“Working with connectors” on page 121.

Lines and

Arrows

Draws a line ending in an arrow. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to show the available options. Note that the title of this submenu when undocked from the Drawing toolbar is Arrows.

Basic

Shapes

Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open a toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Select the desired basic shape, then draw it by placing your cursor on the slide and dragging your mouse to define an enclosing rectangle. Keep the Shift key pressed to obtain a basic shape where the height and width are equal. Press the Alt key to draw a basic shape from its center.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 105

Tool Name

Symbol

Shapes

Purpose

Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open a toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Select the desired symbol shape, then draw it by placing your cursor on the slide and dragging your mouse to define an enclosing rectangle. Keep the Shift key pressed to obtain a symbol shape where the height and width are equal. Press the Alt key to draw a symbol shape from its center.

Block

Arrows

Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open a toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Select the desired block arrow, then draw it by placing your cursor on the slide and dragging your mouse to define an enclosing rectangle. Keep the Shift key pressed to obtain a block arrow where the height and width are equal. Press the Alt key to draw a block arrow from its center.

Flowcharts Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open a toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Select the desired flowchart shape, then draw it by placing your cursor on the slide and dragging your mouse to define an enclosing rectangle. Keep the Shift key pressed to obtain a flowchart where the height and width are equal. Press the Alt key to draw a flowchart shape from its center.

Callouts Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open a toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Select the desired callout, then draw it by placing your cursor on the slide and dragging your mouse to define an enclosing rectangle. Keep the Shift key pressed to obtain a callout where the height and width are equal. Press the Alt key to draw a callout from its center.

106 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Tool Name

Stars

Purpose

Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open a toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Select the desired star, then draw it by placing your cursor on the slide and dragging your mouse to define an enclosing rectangle.

Keep the Shift key pressed to obtain a star where the height and width are equal. Press the Alt key to draw a star from its center. Note that the title of this submenu when undocked from the Drawing toolbar is Stars and

Banners.

Points

Glue Points

Fontwork

Gallery

From File

Gallery

Extrusion

On/Off

Edits the individual points that form the shape or line. Select this tool and then select a shape or a line. You can also press the F8 key to select this tool.

Edits the glue points of a graphic object. Glue points are the positions

where connector lines terminate or start. See “Managing glue points” on page 122 for instructions.

Opens the Fontwork gallery. See “Using Fontwork” on page 126

for further information.

Equivalent to Insert > Picture > From file on the main menu bar. See

Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures for details.

Opens the gallery. Equivalent to Tools > Gallery on the main menu bar.

See Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures for details.

Switches 3D effects on or off for the selected object. Clicking this button

also opens the 3D settings toolbar. See “Working with 3D objects” on page

123 for details.

Additional drawing tools

In addition to the default set of drawing tools available on the Drawing toolbar (Figure 80), you can

install additional tools. These additional tools are described in Table 4.

To install or remove additional tools onto or from the Drawing toolbar:

1) Right-click on an empty area on the Drawing toolbar.

2) Select Visible Buttons from the context menu to display a list of the available tools.

3) To install a tool, click on it and the tool will appear in the Drawing toolbar. The list of available tools will close automatically. Installed tools are indicated by a border around the icon.

4) To remove a tool, click on it and the tool is removed from the Drawing toolbar. Uninstalling a tool removes the border around the tool icon. The list of available tools will close automatically.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 107

Table 4: Additional drawing tools

Tool Name

3D Objects

Purpose

Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open a toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected. Select the desired 3D shape, then draw it by placing your cursor on the slide and dragging your mouse to define an enclosing rectangle. Keep the Shift key pressed to obtain a 3D shape where the height and width are equal. Press the Alt key to draw a 3D shape from its center.

To Curve

To Polygon

To 3D

To 3D

Rotation

Object

Insert

Converts the selected object to a Bézier curve.

Converts the selected object to a polygon (a closed object bounded by straight lines). The appearance of the object does not change. If you want, you can right-click and choose Edit Points to view the changes.

Converts the selected 2D object to a 3D object.

Converts the selected 2D object to a 3D rotation object.

Allows you to insert a slide, table, from file, movie and sound, formula, or chart into your presentation. Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open the Insert toolbar showing the available options. Actual icon shown will depend on the option that has been selected.

Controls Allows you to insert various form controls into your presentation. Click the triangle to the right of the tool icon to open the Form Controls toolbar showing the available options.

Animated

Image

Adds animation to a selected object on a slide. Opens the Animation dialog.

Creating lines and shapes

Creating shapes and lines is basically the same procedure for all lines and shapes:

1) Click on the triangle to the right of the tool you want to use on the Drawing toolbar and select the desired tool from the available selection. Note that the tools on the Drawing toolbar show the last tool shape selected.

2) Position your cursor on the slide, then click and drag to create the line or shape.

108 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

3) Release the mouse button when you have drawn your line or shape. You can then modify and reposition your line or shape using the procedures described later in this chapter.

Regular shapes

When creating shapes that are included in Impress, one or more dots may be displayed in a different color to the selection handles. These dots perform a different function according to the shape they are applied to, as listed below.

Basic Shapes

Rounded rectangle and rounded square – use the dot to change the radius of the curve that replaces the angled corners of a rectangle or square.

Circle pie – use the dots to change the size of the filled sector.

Isosceles triangle – use the dot to modify the shape and type of the triangle.

Trapezoid, parallelogram, hexagon, or octagon – use the dot to change the internal angles between the sides.

Cross – use the dot to change the thickness of the four arms of the cross.

Ring – use the dot to change the internal diameter of the ring.

Block arc – use the dot to change both internal diameter and size of the filled area.

Cylinder and cube – use the dot to change the perspective.

Folded corner – use the dot to change the size of the folded corner.

Frame – use the dot to change the thickness of the frame.

Symbol Shapes

Smiley face – use the dot to change the smile on the face.

Sun, moon and heart – use the dot to change the shape of the symbol.

Prohibited symbol – use the dot to change the thickness of the ring and the diagonal bar.

Double bracket, left bracket, right bracket and double brace – use the dot to change the curvature of the bracket.

Left brace and right brace – use the dots to change the curvature of the brace and the position of the point.

Square bevel, octagon bevel and diamond bevel – use the dot to change the thickness of the bevel.

Block Arrows

Left arrow, right arrow, up arrow, down arrow, left and right arrow, up and down arrow,

striped right arrow and notched right arrow – use the dot to change the shape and thickness of the arrows.

Up and right arrow, up, right and down arrow and 4-way arrow – use the dots to change the shape and thickness of the arrows.

Pentagon and chevron – use the dot to change the angle between the sides and the shape.

Right arrow callout, left arrow callout, up arrow callout, down arrow callout, left and right

arrow callout, up and down arrow callout, up and right arrow callout and 4-way arrow

callout – use the dots to change the shape and thickness of the callouts.

Circular arrow – use the dots to change the thickness and area of the arrow.

Callouts

For all callouts use the dots to change the length, position and angle of the pointer.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 109

Stars

4-point star, 8-point star and 24-point star – use the dot to change the thickness and shape of the star points.

Vertical scroll and horizontal scroll – use the dot to change the width and shape of the scroll.

Doorplate – use the dot to change the inward curvature of the corners.

Curves, polygons and freeform lines

To draw a curve, polygon or freeform line click the Curve icon on the Drawing toolbar. Note that the default action of this tool is to show the last selected tool and, by default, the last selected tool will be used. To use a different tool, click on the triangle to the right of the icon to open the

tools that are available (Figure 81 and Table 5). Note that the title of this tool submenu when

undocked from the Drawing toolbar is Lines.

If a filled curve, polygon or freeform line was selected, Impress draws the line connecting the last point to the start point and fills the inside area with the default color.

Figure 81: Lines (curves) toolbar

Table 5: Curve, polygon and freeform tools

Icon Tool name Icon

Curve filled

Tool name Icon

Polygon filled

Tool name Icon Tool name

Polygon 45° filled

Freeform line filled

Curve Polygon Polygon 45° Freeform line

Curves

1) Select either Curve filled or Curve.

2) Click and hold the left mouse button to create the starting point of your curve.

3) While holding down the left mouse button, drag from the starting point to draw a line.

4) Release the left mouse button and continue to drag the cursor to bend the line into a curve.

5) Click to set the end point of the curve and fix the line on the page.

6) To continue with your line, drag the mouse cursor to draw a straight line. Each mouse click sets a corner point and allows you to continue drawing another straight line from the corner point.

7) Double click to end the drawing of your line.

Note

Holding down the Shift key when drawing lines with the Curve or Polygon tools will also restrict the angles between the lines to 45 or 90 degrees.

Polygons

1) Select either Polygon filled or Polygon.

2) Click and draw the first line from the start point with the left mouse button held down. As soon as you release the mouse button, a line between the first and second points is drawn.

110 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

3) Move the cursor to draw the next line. Each mouse click sets a corner point and allows you to draw another line.

4) Double-click to end the drawing of your polygon.

Polygons 45°

Select either Polygon (45°) filled or Polygon (45°) and these polygons are drawn in the same way as polygons above. However, the angles between line segments are restricted to 45 or 90 degrees as you draw your polygon.

Freeform lines

Using the Freeform Line tools is similar to drawing with a pencil on paper.

1) Select either Freeform line filled or Freeform line.

2) Press and hold the left mouse button and drag the cursor to the line shape you require.

3) When you finished drawing your freeform line, release the mouse button and the drawing is completed.

Grouping objects together

It is often convenient to group objects together so that they are treated as a single object by

Impress. A group of objects can be formatted as if it was a single object, moved, rotated, deleted and so on.

This section only gives a brief introduction to grouping of objects. For more information on working with grouped objects, see the Draw Guide Chapter 5 Combining Multiple Objects.

Grouping

To group objects together:

1) Select the objects to be grouped using the selection tool on the Drawing toolbar and draw a rectangle around the objects to be grouped, or hold down the Shift key and click on each object. To select all the objects, go to Edit > Select All on the main menu bar or use the keyboard combination Ctrl+A.

2) When the selection handles are displayed, go to Format > Group > Group on the main menu bar or use the keyboard combination Ctrl+Shift+G or right-click on an object within the selected group and select Group from the context menu.

Editing or formatting groups

To edit or format a group of objects:

1) Click on any one of the objects in the group to select the group. Any editing or formatting is then carried out on all the objects within the group.

2) To edit an individual object within a group: a) After selecting the group, press the F3 key or go to Format > Group > Enter Group on the main menu bar or right-click and select Enter Group from the context menu.

b) Select individual objects within the group for editing or formatting.

c) When you have finished editing or formatting, use the keyboard combination Ctrl+F3 or go to Format > Group > Exit group on the main menu bar or right-click and select Exit

Group from the context menu. The whole group then becomes selected.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 111

Ungrouping

To ungroup objects:

1) Click on any one of the objects in the group to select the group.

2) When the selection handles are displayed, go to Format > Group > Ungroup on the menu bar or use the keyboard combination Ctrl+Alt+Shift+G or right-click on the group and select

Ungroup from the context menu.

Tip

If you use the group and ungroup commands often, why not add them to one of the toolbars shown by default so that the commands are readily available? To do so, you will need to customize the selected toolbar. See Chapter 11 Setting Up and

Customizing Impress.

Moving graphic objects

To move a graphic object:

1) Click on a graphic object or a group of objects to display the selection handles.

2) Move the cursor over a selected graphic object until the cursor changes shape. For example, on most operating systems, the cursor associated with moving objects is a clenched hand or a four-headed arrow.

3) Click and drag the graphic object to the desired position. You can also use the arrow keys to move the selected object or group to a new position.

4) Release the mouse button.

Tip

By default Impress makes the objects snap to the grid. If you need to position the object between two points of the grid, hold down the Ctrl key, then click on the object and move it to the desired position. Alternatively, you can turn off this snap function or modify the grid resolution by going to Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress >

Grid.

112

Figure 82: Position and Size dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

For a more accurate placement of the graphic object, use the Position and Size dialog (Figure 82):

1) With the object selected and the selection handles displayed, press F4 or go to Format >

Position and Size on the main menu bar, or right-click on the selected object and select

Position and Size from the context menu.

2) Click on the Position and Size tab.

3) Use the Position section of the dialog to specify the X (horizontal) and Y (vertical) position of the graphic object. The values represent the distance of the base point selected on the right hand side of the dialog. The default selection for base point is relative to the top left corner of the slide.

4) To prevent accidental modification of the position of the graphic object, select the Position option in the Protect section of the dialog.

5) Click OK when satisfied and to close the dialog.

The units of measurement for this dialog and other dialogs are set in Tools > Options >

LibreOffice Impress > General.

Resizing graphic objects

To resize a graphic object:

1) Click on a graphic object or a group of objects to display the selection handles.

2) Position the pointer over one of the selection handles. The pointer changes shape giving a graphical representation of the direction of the resizing. The corner handles resize both the width and the height of the graphic object simultaneously, while the other four handles resize only one dimension at a time.

3) Click and drag to resize the graphic object.

4) Release the mouse button to complete resizing.

Tip

To retain the original proportions of the graphic, Shift+click one of the corner handles, then drag. Release the mouse button before releasing the Shift key.

For more accurate resizing of the graphic object, use the Position and Size dialog (Figure 82):

1) With the object selected and the selection handles displayed, press F4 or go to Format >

Position and Size on the main menu bar, or right-click on the selected object and select

Position and Size from the context menu.

2) Click on the Position and Size tab.

3) Select as the base point the part of the graphic object that you would like to anchor to the page. The default selection of top left corner means, that when resizing, the position of the top left corner of the object will not change.

4) Now modify either the Width value or the Height value of the object in the Size section.

5) To maintain the proportions between width and height, select the Keep ratio option before modifying any value. When Keep ratio is selected, changes to one dimension results in an automatic change to the other with the ratio between width and height maintained.

6) To prevent accidental modifications of the size, select the Size option in the Protect section of the dialog.

7) Click OK when satisfied and to close the dialog.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 113

Applying special effects

As well as the basic actions of moving and resizing an object, a number of special effects can also be applied to objects in Impress. Several of these effects are readily available in the Mode toolbar

(Figure 83). If the Mode toolbar is not showing, select it from View > Toolbars > Mode.

This section describes how to rotate, flip, distort and two ways of setting an object in a circle. The transparency and gradient tools are more specific to formatting and are discussed in Chapter 6

Formatting Graphic Objects.

Figure 83: Mode toolbar and available options

Figure 84: Object selected for rotation

Rotating graphic objects

Rotation of an object can be carried out manually or using a dedicated dialog, just like changing object position and size. To rotate a graphic manually:

1) Click on a graphic object and the selection handles will show.

2) Click the Rotate icon on the Line and Filling or Mode toolbars or click again on the

graphic object. The square selection handles change shape and also change color (Figure

84). Also a pivot point indicating the rotation center appears in the center of the object.

3) Move the mouse over one of the corner handles and the mouse cursor shape will change.

114 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

4) Click the mouse and move in the direction in which you want to rotate the graphic object.

Only the corner selection handles are active for rotation.

5) When satisfied with the rotation, release the mouse button.

6) To change the rotation center of the object, click and drag the pivot point to the desired position before rotating. The pivot point can be moved to any position on the slide, even outside of the object boundaries.

7) To restrict the rotation angles to multiples of 15 degrees, press and hold the Shift key while rotating the graphic. This is very handy for rotating pictures through a right angle, for example from portrait to landscape. Remember to release the Shift key before releasing the mouse button.

Note

The icons representing the functions in the toolbars may be different depending on the operating system used and on whether LibreOffice has been customized. When in doubt, hover the mouse over an icon and wait for the tooltip to appear showing the name of the icon.

Instead of rotating a graphic object manually, you can use the Rotation dialog (Figure 85) to

accurately rotate an object in degrees:

1) With the object selected and the selection handles displayed, press F4 or go to Format >

Position and Size on the main menu bar, or right-click on the selected object and select

Position and Size from the context menu.

2) Click on the Rotation tab.

3) In the Pivot point section, select the position of the pivot point. The default position of the pivot point is the center of the object.

4) In the Rotation angle section, enter the degrees in the Angle text box by which to rotate the graphic object. Alternatively, in Default settings, click on the Rotation Angle indicator and drag it to a new angle.

5) Click OK when satisfied and to close the dialog.

Figure 85: Rotation page of the Position and Size dialog

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 115

Flipping objects

The quickest and easiest method to flip an object horizontally or vertically is as follows:

1) Click on a graphic object and the selection handles will show.

2) Right-click and select Flip > Horizontally or Flip > Vertically from the context menu and the selected object will be flipped to face the other direction.

Figure 86: Using the Flip tool

The Flip tool on the Drawing or Mode toolbar can also be used. Using this tool also allows you to

change the position and angle that the object flips over (Figure 86).

1) Click on a graphic object and the selection handles will show.

2) Click on the Flip icon on the Drawing or Mode toolbar and the axis of symmetry appears as a dashed line through the center of the object. The object will be flipped about this axis of symmetry.

3) Click and drag the axis of symmetry to a new position, or position the cursor in one of the circles at each end of the axis of symmetry and drag with your mouse cursor to change the angle.

4) Place the mouse cursor over one of the object selection handles until it changes shape.

5) Click and drag your cursor across the axis of symmetry to flip the object. The new position of the object is shown faintly until the mouse is released.

6) Release the mouse button and the object will appear flipped over. Angle and position of the flip will depend on the angle and position of the axis of symmetry.

Note

If you press the Shift key while moving the axis of symmetry, it will rotate in 45-degree increments.

Mirror copies

At the moment there is no mirror command existing in Impress. However, mirroring an object can be emulated by flipping the object:

1) Select the object you want to make a mirror copy of and copy the object to the clipboard.

2) Flip the object using one of the methods in “Flipping objects”, then move the flipped object

to one side.

3) Click on an empty area of the page to deselect the object.

4) Paste from the clipboard to put a copy of the object into your slide.

116 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

5) Select both images, then right-click and select Alignment from the context menu.

6) Select the type of alignment you want to use. Top, Center, or Bottom if you are creating a horizontal mirror copy. Left, Centered, or Right if you are creating a vertical mirror copy.

Distorting images

Three tools on the Mode toolbar (Figure 83 on page 114) let you drag the corners and edges of an

object to distort the image. The Distort icon distorts an object in perspective, the Set to Circle

(slant) icon and Set in Circle (perspective) icon both create a pseudo three-dimensional effect. Note that when using these tools, you have to transform an object to a curve before distorting.

Distort tool

1) Select an object and click on the Distort icon on the Mode toolbar.

2) Click Yes to convert the object to a curve. If the object is already a curve, this dialog does not appear.

3) Click and drag a corner selection handle to distort the object using the opposite corner selection handle as an anchor point for the distortion.

4) Click and drag the vertical selection handles to distort the object using the opposite vertical side as an anchor point for the distortion.

5) Click and drag the horizontal selection handles to distort the object using the opposite horizontal side as an anchor point for the distortion.

Figure 87: Distorting an object

Set in circle (perspective) tool

1) Select an object and click on the Set in Circle (perspective) icon in the Mode toolbar.

2) Click Yes to convert the object to a curve. If the object is already a curve, this dialog does not appear.

3) Click and drag one of the selection handles to give a pseudo three-dimensional perspective

using the opposite side as an anchor point (Figure 88). A ghosted image appears as you

drag to give you and indication of the resulting object will look.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 117

Figure 88: Setting an image to a circle with perspective

Set to circle (slant) tool

1) Select an object and click on the Set to Circle (slant) icon in the Mode toolbar.

2) Click Yes to convert the object to a curve. If the object is already a curve, this dialog does not appear.

3) Click and drag one of the selection handles to give a pseudo three-dimensional perspective

using the opposite side as an anchor point (Figure 89). A ghosted image appears as you

drag to give you and indication of the resulting object will look.

Note

Figure 89: Setting an image to a circle with slant

Transforming an object into a curve is a safe operation, but it cannot be reversed other than by using the Undo function.

Aligning objects

Use the alignment tools to adjust the relative position of a graphic object compared to another object.

Click on the triangle to the right of the Alignment icon in the Line and Filling toolbar or go to

View > Toolbars > Align on the main menu bar to open the Align toolbar (Figure 90). The

Alignment icon shown on the Line and Filling toolbar will depend on the alignment option that had been previously selected. The alignment options are also available when you right-click on selected objects.

If only one object is selected, the alignment options are not available.

The toolbar has six tools available:

Left, Center, Right – determines the horizontal alignment of the selected objects.

Top, Center, Bottom – determines the vertical alignment of the selected objects.

118 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 90: Align toolbar

Snapping objects to grid or snap guides

Sometimes it is important to align objects to specific points of the page or to make sure that objects that appear on multiple slides are placed in exactly the same position. For this purpose Impress provides two mechanisms: Grid and Snap Guides (also called Snap Lines).

Using the grid

Options for the grid are available by right-clicking on an empty part of the page in Normal view and choosing Grid or by selecting View > Grid from the menu bar. The options available from the context menu that opens are:

Display Grid – displays the grid.

Snap to Grid – the anchor points of an object will be placed on a grid when the object is moved or resized.

Grid to Front – displays the grid in the foreground.

To set up the grid spacing and snapping options, go to Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress >

Grid on the menu bar.

Using snap guides

Options for the guides are available by right clicking on an empty part of the page in Normal view and choosing Snap Lines or by selecting View > Snap Lines from the menu bar. The options available from the context menu that opens are:

Display Guides – the guides are shown on the slide.

Snap to Snap Lines – the anchor points of the objects snap to the guides when the object is moved or resized.

Snap Lines to Front – displays the guides in the foreground.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 119

Tip

Figure 91: New Snap Object dialog

Creating a new guide

1) Right-click on an empty part of the work area and select Insert Snap Point/Line from the

context menu to open the New Snap Object dialog (Figure 91).

2) Specify the type of snap object. Depending on the choice made determines which field becomes active: a) Point both X and Y fields become active.

b) Vertical only X field becomes active.

c) Horizontal only Y field become active.

3) Enter the position of the guide.

4) Click OK to close the dialog.

When positioning the Snap Guides, it is useful to display the rulers. To do so, select

View > Rulers. Drag a Snap Guide directly onto the slide by clicking on the ruler and then dragging onto the slide.

Editing guides

1) Right-click next to or on the guide to be edited.

2) Select Edit Snap line from the context menu.

3) Enter a new value in the X or Y field for the guide position and click OK.

Deleting guides

1) Right-click next or on the guide to be deleted.

2) Select Delete Snap line from the context menu.

Arranging objects

Impress organizes objects in a stack so that the objects on the top level of the stack cover the objects on lower levels if any overlapping occurs. The stack level of each object can be changed by arranging shapes on a slide or page.

120 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 92: Position toolbar

To change the stack level of an object, select an object or objects and then click the small triangle on the side of the Arrange icon on the Line and Filling toolbar to open the Position toolbar

(Figure 92). The Arrange icon shown on the Line and Filling toolbar will depend on the arrange

option that had been previously selected. The arrange options are also available by right-clicking on a selected object.

The first four tools determine the stack level of a selected object:

Bring to front: – the selected object is moved in front of all other objects.

Bring forward – the selected object is moved one level up in the stack.

Send backwards – the selected object is moved one level down in the stack.

Send to back – the selected object is moved behind all other objects.

The other three tools determine the relative positions of the selected objects:

In front of object – moves the first selected object in front of the second selected object.

Behind object – moves the first selected object behind the second selected object.

Reverse – swaps the stacking order of two selected objects.

To use the In front of object and Behind object tools:

1) Select the first object by clicking on it.

2) Select In front of object or Behind object from the context menu and the mouse cursor changes to a pointing hand.

3) Click on the second object and the objects swap positions.

Working with connectors

Connectors are lines that can be anchored to particular places, called glue points, on an object.

The advantage of connectors is that when an object with a connector attached is moved or resized, the connector automatically adjusts to the change. When creating a flowchart, organization chart, schematics or diagrams, it is highly recommended to use connectors instead of simple lines.

When a connector is drawn or selected Impress displays selection handles which are not shown for normal lines. The termination points of a connector are square at the start of a connector and round at the end of a connector. The selection handles on a connector are used to modify the routing of a connector where applicable.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 121

Impress offers a wide variety of predefined connectors, which differ in the termination shape (none, arrow, custom) and in the way the connector is drawn (straight, line, curved).

Drawing connectors

A simple method of drawing is as follows. For more information on how to format a connector, refer to Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects.

1) Click on the triangle next to the Connector icon on the Drawing toolbar and select the type of connector you want to use. The Connector icon shown on the Drawing toolbar will depend on the connector that had been previously selected and used.

2) Move the mouse cursor over one of the objects to be connected and small crosses appear around the object edges which are the glue points to which a connector can be attached

(Figure 93).

Figure 93: Example of using a connector

3) Click on the required glue point to attach one end of the connector, then hold the mouse button down and drag the connector to another object.

4) When the cursor is over the glue point of the target object release the mouse button and the connector is drawn.

5) The selection handles that appear on the connector are used to adjust the path of the connector so that the connector does not cover another object in its path.

Managing glue points

A glue point is the attachment point for a connector on an object. Each object shape has a number of predefined glue points, but it is possible to define new ones, as well as edit them, using the

Gluepoints toolbar.

1) Click on the Gluepoints icon on the Drawing toolbar or go to View > Toolbars >

Gluepoints on the main menu bar to open the toolbar (Figure 94).

2) Select an object on your slide.

3) To insert a new glue point onto the selected object, click on the Insert Glue Point icon.

4) If you want to fix the direction a connector uses when connecting to a glue point, click on one of the exit direction icons. This is useful if you have multiple connectors terminating on one side of an object or the position of the default glue point is not satisfactory.

5) Move the cursor to the position you require on the selected object, then click the mouse button to insert the glue point.

6) Make sure that the Glue point relative icon is selected to maintain the relative position of a glue point when resizing the object.

7) Deselecting the Glue point relative icon activates the remaining six icons on the toolbar.

Use these tools to fix the position of the glue point during the resizing of the object.

8) To delete a glue point you have inserted, select it with the cursor and press the Delete key.

The default glue points on an object cannot be deleted.

122 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

9) To move a glue point you have inserted, select it with the cursor and drag the glue point to a new position. The default glue points on an object cannot be moved.

Tip

Figure 94: Gluepoints toolbar and available options

Glue points are placed by default on the grid (see “Snapping objects to grid or snap guides” on page 119 for information). However it is sometimes necessary to fine tune

the position of a glue point depending on the shape of the object. To do this, press the Ctrl key to display guide lines and keep the Ctrl key pressed while dragging the glue point to the new position.

Working with 3D objects

Although Impress offers advanced functions to manipulate 3D objects, this guide describes only the 3D settings applicable to an object. For additional information on how to use advanced 3D effects such as geometry and shading, refer to the Draw Guide.

3D objects can be created in Impress in any of the following ways:

Click on the triangle to the right of the 3D Objects icon on the Drawing toolbar and select a 3D object from the options. After selection, draw your 3D object on your slide as you would with any object. The 3D Objects icon shown on the Drawing toolbar will depend on the 3D object that had been previously selected and used.

Go to View > Toolbars > 3D-Objects on the main menu bar to open the 3D-Objects

toolbar (Figure 95). The selection and drawing of 3D objects is the same as clicking on the

3D Objects icon on the Drawing toolbar.

Figure 95: 3D-Objects toolbar

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 123

Right-click on an object already on your slide and select Convert > To 3D or To 3D

Rotation Object from the context menu. To 3D adds thickness to the object to create a 3D object. To 3D Rotation Object creates a 3D object by rotating the object around an axis.

Select an object and click on the Extrusion on/off icon on the Drawing toolbar to apply a basic 3D effect and open the 3D-Settings toolbar. Select one of the options on the

3D-Settings toolbar to apply a different 3D effect (Figure 96 and Table 6).

Figure 96: 3D-Settings toolbar

Table 6: 3D-Settings tools and their purpose

Tool Name

Extrusion On/Off

Purpose

Adds thickness to an object and activates the 3D properties.

Tilt Down Tilts the object downwards around a horizontal axis.

Tilt Up Tilts the object up around a horizontal axis.

Tilt Left

Tilt Right

Depth

Direction

Lighting

Surface

3D Color

Tilts the object left around a vertical axis.

Tilts the object right around a vertical axis.

Determines the thickness of the shape. An extended toolbar opens where some default values are given. If none of the values are satisfactory, select Custom and then enter the desired thickness.

Opens an extended toolbar that lets you pick the direction of the perspective as well as the type (parallel or perspective).

Opens an extended toolbar that lets you specify the direction and intensity of light.

Choose between Wire frame (useful when manipulating the object),

Matt, Plastic or Metal.

Selects the color of the object thickness.

Note

Most of the Fontwork shapes (see “Using Fontwork” on page 126) have 3D

properties and can be manipulated with the 3D-Settings toolbar.

Converting objects to different types

You can convert an object into a different type. Right-click on the object and select Convert from the context menu to display the following options:

To Curve – converts the selected object to a Bézier curve. Click on the Points icon on the Drawing toolbar to edit the points after conversion to a Bézier curve.

124 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

To Polygon – converts the selected object to a polygon. Click on the Points icon to edit the object after conversion to a polygon. A polygon always consists of straight segments.

To Contour – for basic shapes, this is equivalent to converting to polygon. For more complex shapes (or for text objects) this conversion creates a group of polygons that you can then manipulate by pressing F3 to enter the group.

To 3D – converts the selected object to a 3D object.

To 3D Rotation Object – creates a three-dimensional shape by rotating the selected object around its vertical axis.

To Bitmap – converts the selected object to a bitmap.

To Metafile – converts the selected object to Windows Metafile Format (WMF), containing both bitmap and vector graphic data.

Note

In most cases the conversion to a different type does not produce immediately visible results.

Tip

To Curve, To Polygon, To 3D and To 3D Rotation Object can be added to the

Drawing toolbar as additional tools by right-clicking in an empty area on the toolbar and selecting Visible Buttons.

Setting up interaction with an object

You can associate an object to an action that is performed when it is clicked. To create an interaction:

1) Select the object for which an interaction will be created.

2) Click on the Interaction icon the Line and Filling toolbar or right-click on the object

and select Interaction from the context menu to open the Interaction dialog (Figure 97).

3) Select the interaction type and the parameters (if applicable). The interactions are

explained in Table 7 and the Interaction dialog changes depending on the type of

interaction selected.

4) Click OK to close the dialog.

5) To remove an interaction from a graphic object follow Steps 1 to 2 and then select No

action as the interaction type at Step 3.

Figure 97: Interaction dialog

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 125

Table 7: Interaction types and their parameters

Interaction

Go to previous slide

Parameters

No parameters.

Go to next slide No parameters.

Go to first slide

Go to last slide

Go to page or object

Go to document

Play sound

Run program

Run macro

Exit presentation

No parameters.

No parameters.

Specify the target from the list in the Target box. You can search for a specific target in the Slide/Object box at the bottom of the screen.

Select the document in the Document box. Use the Browse button to open a File Open dialog. If the document to be opened is in Open Document

Presentation format, the target list will be populated allowing selection of the specific target.

Select the file containing the sound to be played. Use the Browse button to open a File Open dialog.

Select the program to execute. Use the Browse button to open a File Open dialog.

Select a macro that will run during the presentation. Use the Browse button to open the Macro Selector dialog.

When the mouse is clicked over the object, the presentation will terminate.

Using Fontwork

Use Fontwork to obtain special text effects. For more about this topic, see the Getting Started

Guide Chapter 11 Graphics, the Gallery, and Fontwork.

To start using Fontwork:

1) Click on the Fontwork Gallery icon on the Drawing toolbar or on the Fontwork toolbar to open the Fontwork Gallery dialog.

2) Select the preferred style from the Fontwork Gallery dialog (Figure 98) and click OK. The

text Fontwork in the selected style appears on the slide. You can modify its shape and properties after it has been placed on the slide.

3) Double-click the object to edit the Fontwork text. Type your own text to replace the word

Fontwork that appears over the object.

4) Press the Esc key or click outside the area with the selection handles to exit.

You can edit some of its attributes by using the Fontwork toolbar or tools that are used to change attributes of objects.

126 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 98: Fontwork Gallery

Using the Fontwork toolbar

Make sure that the Fontwork toolbar (Figure 99) is visible on the workspace. If not, select View >

Toolbars > Fontwork from the main menu bar.

Figure 99: Fontwork toolbar

In addition to the Fontwork Gallery icon, this toolbar contains the following tools:

Fontwork Shape

– changes the shape of the selected object. Shapes are selected from the options that become available when you click on the icon.

Fontwork Same Letter Heights

– changes the height of characters in the selected object. Toggles between normal height where characters have different heights to where all characters are the same height.

Fontwork Alignment:

– specifies the text alignment within the frame from the options available.

Fontwork Character Spacing

– selects the desired spacing between characters and whether kerning pairs should be used. For custom spacing, input a percentage value:

100% is normal spacing; less than 100% is tight spacing; more than 100% is expanded spacing.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 127

Modifying Fontwork as an object

It is possible to treat Fontwork text as an object and therefore to apply to it all the formatting that has been described in this chapter. Assign line properties only to Fontwork which does not have a

3D effect, otherwise the changes will not be visible.

You can modify some of the Fontwork shapes just as you modify the angles of trapezoid and parallelogram basic shapes by moving the dot that is displayed along with the selection handles.

Animations

Animated slide transitions can be added between slides to give your presentation a more professional look when you change to the next slide (see Chapter 9 Slide Shows for more information on transitions). However, Impress also allows you to add animations onto the slides to create more interest in your presentation.

An animation consists of a sequence of images or objects called frames that are displayed in succession when the animation runs. Each frame may contain one or more objects. For example, make bullet points appear one by one; make pictures, shapes or other objects appear singly or as a group onto a slide. Animations can be controlled using the keyboard or mouse click or automatically in a timed sequence.

There are two ways to create an animation in Impress: see “Custom Animation” below or “Inserting animated images” on page 131.

Tip

Animations can look great in a presentation, but overuse of animations can make a good presentation into a poor presentation. Always use discretion when adding animations to your presentation.

Custom Animation

The Custom Animation section (Figure 100) is located in the Tasks pane to the right of the

Workspace in Impress. It is used to add an animation effect to an object on a slide, or change the animation effect of an object.

Note

Anything that can be placed onto a slide is an object. For example, an object can include a picture, clip art drawing or text and so on.

Custom animation section

The Custom Animation section allows you to control the animation.

Add – opens the Custom Animation dialog (Figure 101) to add an animation effect to an

object on the slide.

Change – opens the Custom Animation dialog to change the animation effect of an animated object.

Remove – removes any animation effects from an object.

Start – displays the start property of the selected animation effect:

On click – the animation stops at this effect until the next mouse click.

With previous – the animation runs immediately.

After previous – the animation runs as soon as the previous animation ends.

128 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 100: Custom Animation in the Tasks pane

Figure 101: Custom Animation dialog

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 129

Direction – controls how the animation appears on the slide:

From left to bottom

From left to top

From right to bottom

From right to top

Effect Options – selects additional properties of an animation. Click the Effect

Options

button to open the Effect Options dialog (Figure 102) where you can select,

adjust and apply options to the animation effect and timing.

Figure 102: Effect Options dialog

Speed – specifies the speed or duration of the selected animation effect.

Change order – click one of the buttons to move the selected animation effect up or down in the order.

Play – plays the selected animation effect in preview.

Slide Show – starts the slide show from the current slide.

The Custom Animation dialog (Figure 101) also contains the following tabbed pages for creating

custom animation:

Entrance – how an animated object appears on the slide.

Emphasis – how an animated object is emphasized when it appears on the slide.

Exit – how an animated object leaves the slide.

Motion Paths – how an object moves on the slide during animation.

Misc Effects – selects media effects from the miscellaneous effects.

Automatic preview – previews any new or edited animation effects on the slide.

130 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Creating an animation

To create an animated object or objects using Custom Animation:

1) Select an object on a slide.

2) Open the Custom Animation section (Figure 100) by clicking on its name in the Tasks pane,

or go to Slide Show > Custom Animation on the main menu bar, or by using the Custom

Animation icon on the Drawing toolbar.

Note

The Custom Animation icon is an additional tool for the Drawing toolbar. It can be added to the Drawing toolbar by right clicking on an empty area on the Drawing toolbar and selecting Customize Toolbar from the context menu.

3) Click on Add in Custom Animation to open the Custom Animation dialog (Figure 101).

4) Select an effect category and the type of effect you want to apply to the selected object.

5) Select how the effect starts, the direction and the speed (if available) of the effect from the various options included on the drop-down lists.

6) Click Effect Options

to open the Effect Options dialog (Figure 102) to set the effect

options for the animation, then click OK to close the dialog.

7) If necessary, change the appearance order of the objects in the animation using the

Change order arrows.

8) Click Play to check the animation effect.

9) When you are satisfied, click Slide Show to check your presentation.

Inserting animated images

You can create an animated image and then insert it into your presentation by going to Insert >

Animated Image on the main menu bar to open the Animation dialog (Figure 103). The animation

controls are explained in Table 8.

Figure 103: Animation dialog

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 131

Table 8: Animation dialog controls

Control Control Name

First image

Purpose

Jumps to the first image in the animation sequence.

Backwards Plays the animation backwards.

Stop

Play

Stops playing the animation.

Plays the animation.

Last image

Image number

Duration

Loop count

Apply Object

Jumps to the last image in the animation sequence.

Indicates the position of the current image in the animation sequence. If you want to view another image, enter its number or click the up and down arrows.

Enter the number of seconds to display the current image. This option is only available if you select Bitmap object in Animation

group.

Sets the number of times that animation will play. If you want the animation to play continuously, select Max. This option is only available if you select Bitmap object in Animation group.

Adds selected object or objects as a single image.

Apply Objects

Individually

Bitmap object

Create

Adds an image for each selected object. If you select a grouped object, an image is created for each object in the group.

You can also select an animation, such as an animated GIF, and click this icon to open it for editing. When you are finished editing the animation, click Create to insert a new animation into your slide.

Deletes the current image from the animation sequence.

Delete Current

Image

Delete All

Images

Number

Group object

Deletes all images in the animation.

Total number of images in the animation.

Assembles images into a single object so that they can be moved as a group. You can still edit individual objects by double-clicking the group in the slide.

Combines images into a single image.

Inserts the animation into the current slide.

132 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Creating an animation

To create an animation using Insert > Animated Image on the menu bar:

1) Create the object you intend to animate, using the drawing tools.

2) Go to Insert > Animated Image on the menu bar to open the Animation dialog (Figure 103

and Table 8).

3) Select the object and click on Apply Object icon to add it as the first frame of the animation.

4) Apply a transformation or change to the object; for example, rotation, change color, add or remove a character(s) and so on.

5) When you are ready, create the second frame of the animation and click Apply Object again to add another frame to the animation.

6) Repeat steps 3, 4 and 5 until you have created all the desired frames of the animation.

7) Select Bitmap object in Animation group to customize the timing of each of the frames and the number of repetitions for the animation.

8) Set the duration of each frame in the animation in Duration and the number of repetitions in

Max to create a loop for your animation. Selecting Max creates a continuous loop.

9) Click Create and the animated image is placed in the center on your slide.

10) Adjust the position of your animated object on your slide.

Note

If the image to be copied in the Animator consists of several objects, you can choose to treat each object as a separate frame. In this case, click on Apply objects

individually icon. Remember that each object will be centered in the animation.

Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects 133

Chapter

6

Formatting Graphic Objects

Formatting objects

This chapter describes how to format the graphic objects created with the available drawing tools.

The format of each graphic object, in addition to its size, rotation and position on the slide, is determined by a number of attributes that define the line, text and area fill of each object. These attributes (among others) also contribute to a graphics style. Although this chapter discusses mainly the manual formatting of objects, it concludes by showing how to create, apply, modify and delete graphics styles.

Formatting lines

In LibreOffice the term line indicates both a freestanding segment and the outer edge of a shape.

In most cases the properties of the line you can modify are its style (solid, dashed, invisible, and so on), its width and its color. Select the line you need to format and then use the controls on the Line

and Filling toolbar to select your desired options (highlighted in Figure 104).

Figure 104: Common line options on the Line and Filling toolbar

To modify the appearance of a line, go to Format > Line on the main menu bar, or right-click on the line and select Line from the context menu, or select the Line icon on the Line and Filling

toolbar to open the Line dialog (Figure 105) where you can set line properties. This dialog consists

of four pages: Line, Shadow, Line Styles, and Arrow Styles.

Line page

The Line page is where you can set the basic parameters of the line. The page is divided into four sections: Line properties, Arrow styles, Width, and Corner and cap styles. At the bottom of the page is a preview of the applied styles for a line and two different corners, so you can evaluate the corner and cap style selections.

136

Figure 105: Line dialog – Line page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Line properties

The Line Properties section on the left side allows you to set the following parameters:

Line style – several line styles are available from the drop-down list, but more line styles can be defined if necessary.

Color – choose from the predefined colors in the drop down list or refer to “Custom colors” on page 144 to create a new color.

Width – specifies the thickness of the line.

Transparency – sets the transparency of a line. Figure 106 illustrates the effects of

different percentages of transparency to lines when placed over an object.

Figure 106: Line transparency effect

Arrow styles

The Arrow styles section is only applicable to individual lines and is not used for lines that form the

borders of an object. To create a new arrow style, see “Arrow styles page” on page 139.

Style – sets the style of the two ends of a line. The left drop down menu is for where you start the line and the right drop down menu is for where you end the line.

Width – specifies the thickness of the arrow endings

Center – moves the center of the arrow endings to the end point of the line. Figure 107

shows the effects of selecting this option.

Synchronize ends – makes the two line ends identical.

Figure 107: Line arrow endings

Arrowheads

A quick way to set the arrowheads for a selected line is to click on the Arrow Style icon in the

Line and Filling toolbar (Figure 104

) to open the Arrowheads toolbar (Figure 108). Use this toolbar

to select one of the many predefined arrowhead styles for the start and ending of a selected line.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 137

Figure 108: Arrowheads menu

Corner and cap styles

Corner and cap styles determine how the connection between two segments of a line looks. There are four available options for corner styles (none, Rounded, Mitered, Beveled) and three cap styles

(Flat, Round, Square). To appreciate the difference between corner and cap styles, choose a thick line style and observe how the preview changes as you select each option.

Shadow page

Use the Shadow page of the Line dialog to add and format the line shadow. The settings on this

page are the same as those for shadows applied to other objects and are described in Formatting shadows on page 151.

A quicker way to apply a shadow to a line is using the Shadow icon on the Line and Filling

toolbar (Figure 104). The main disadvantage of using the Shadow icon is that the shadow

appearance will be constrained by the shadow settings of the default graphics style.

Line styles page

Use the Line Styles page (Figure 109) of the Line dialog to create new line styles as well as

loading previously saved line styles. It is recommended to create new styles when necessary than to modify the predefined styles.

To create a new line style:

1) Choose Format > Line from the menu bar, or right-click on the line and select Line from the context menu, or select the Line icon from the Line and Filling toolbar.

2) Click on the Line Styles tab.

3) Select from the Line style drop-down menu a style similar to the style you want to create.

4) Click Add. On the pop-up dialog, type a name for the new line style and click OK.

138 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 109: Line dialog – Line Styles page

5) Now define the new style. Start by selecting the line type for the new style. To alternate two line types (for example, dashes and dots) within a single line, select different types in the two Type boxes.

6) Specify the Number and Length (not available for dot style) of each of the types of line selected.

7) Set the Spacing between the various elements

8) If necessary, select Fit to line width so that the new style fits the width of the selected line.

9) The new line style created is available only in the current document. If you want to use the line style in other presentations, click the Save Line Styles icon and type a unique filename in the Save as dialog that opens. Saved styles have the file extension of .sod.

10) To use previously saved line styles, click the Load Line Styles icon and select a style from the list of saved styles. Click Open to load the style into your presentation.

11) If necessary, click on the Modify button to change the name of the style.

Arrow styles page

Use the Arrow Styles page (Figure 110) of the Line dialog to create new arrow styles, or modify

existing arrow styles, or load previously saved arrow styles.

1) First draw a curve in the shape you want to use for the arrowhead or create a shape and

convert to a curve. The top of the shape must face upward, as shown in Figure 111,

because this becomes the point of the arrow.

Note

The arrowhead created must be convertible to a curve. A curve is something you can draw without lifting a pencil. For example, can be converted to a curve, but cannot.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 139

Figure 110: Line dialog – Arrow Styles page

140

Figure 111: Using a pentagon shape for arrow styles

2) Select the shape and, if necessary, right click and choose Convert > To Curve from the context menu to convert the shape to a curve. If the shape is already a curve, To Curve will not be available.

3) With the selection handles showing, select Format > Line from the menu bar, or right-click and choose Line from the context menu.

4) Go to the Arrow Styles page (Figure 110), click the Add button, type a name for the new

arrow style and click OK. The new arrowhead style will be shown in the preview.

5) Now you can access the new style from the Arrow style list. When you select the name of the new style, it is shown at the bottom of the dialog.

6) The new arrowhead style created is available only in the current document. If you want to use this arrowhead style in other presentations, click the Save Line Styles icon and type a unique filename in the Save as dialog that opens. Saved styles have the file extension of .sod.

7) To use previously saved arrowhead styles, click the Load Line Styles icon and select the style from the saved list of styles. Click Open to load the style into your presentation.

8) If necessary. click on the Modify button to change the name of the style.

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Formatting area fills

The term area fill refers to the inside of an object that has an unbroken border, for example a rectangle, circle, star, pentagon and so on. An area fill can be a uniform color, gradient, hatching

pattern, or bitmap (Figure 112). An area fill can also be made partly or wholly transparent and can

throw a shadow.

The Line and Filling toolbar has several tools normally used to quickly format graphic objects. If this toolbar is not visible, go to View > Toolbars > Line and Filling on the menu bar. You can also

use the Area dialog to quickly format objects, see "Using Area dialog" on page 141 for more

information.

Once you have decided on a predefined or custom fill, you can further refine it by adding a shadow

or transparency. See "Formatting shadows" on page 151 and "Formatting transparencies" on page

152 for more information.

Figure 112: Different types of area fill

Using Line and Filling toolbar

Figure 113: Common area fill options highlighted

To quickly format an area fill of an object using the Line and Filling toolbar (Figure 113):

1) Select the object you wish to edit.

2) On the Line and Filling toolbar, click the left Area Style/Filling button and select the type of area fill (Invisible, Color, Gradient, Hatching or Bitmap) you want to use from the options listed in the drop-down list.

3) On the Line and Filling toolbar, click the right Area Style/Filling button and select the color or type of area fill you want to use from the options listed in the drop-down list. The available options change depending on the type of area fill selected. This button is not available when Invisible is selected for the area fill.

Note

If you do not require an area fill for an object, select Invisible from the options available when you click the left Area Style/Filling button on the Line and Filling toolbar.

Using Area dialog

To quickly format an area fill of an object using the Area dialog, use the following procedure. You can also use the Area dialog to create your own area fill.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 141

1) Select the object you wish to edit.

2) Go to Format > Area on the menu bar, or click the Area icon on the Line and Filling toolbar, or right-click on the object and select Area from the context menu to open the Area dialog.

Note

If you do not require a fill for an object when using the Area dialog, select None from the options available.

3) For color area fills, select Color from the drop down list and then select your required color

from the list of available colors (Figure 114).

4) Click OK and the color will appear as an area fill in the selected object.

Figure 114: Area color dialog

5) For gradient area fills, select Gradient from the drop down list and then select your

required gradient from the list of available gradients (Figure 115).

6) To override the number of steps (increments) that are applied to the gradient transition in a gradient fill, deselect Automatic in Increments and then enter the number of steps required in the text box on the right.

7) Click OK and the gradient will appear as an area fill in the selected object.

Figure 115: Area gradient dialog

8) For hatching area fills, select Hatching from the drop down list and then select your

required hatching from the list of available hatchings (Figure 116).

9) Select Background color and select a background color for the hatching from the drop down list.

10) Click OK and the hatching will appear as an area fill in the selected object.

11) For bitmap area fills, select Bitmaps from the drop down list and then select your required

bitmap from the list of available bitmaps (Figure 117).

12) Set the Size, Position and Offset options as necessary. See Table 9 for more information

on bitmap options.

13) Click OK and the bitmap will appear as an area fill in the selected object.

142 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 116: Area hatching dialog

Figure 117: Area bitmap dialog

Table 9: Bitmap options

Option Meaning

Size – Original Retains the original size of the bitmap when filling the selected object. To resize the bitmap, clear this checkbox

Size – Relative When selected, Relative rescales the bitmap relative to the size of the bitmap by percentage values entered in the Width and Height boxes. Clear this checkbox to resize the bitmap using the linear measurements entered in the

Width and Height boxes.

Size – Width

Size – Height

Enter a width for the bitmap. When Relative is selected 100% means that the original bitmap width will be resized to occupy the whole fill area width; 50% means that the width of the bitmap will be half that of the fill area.

Enter a height for the bitmap. When Relative is selected 100% means that the original bitmap height will be resized to occupy the whole fill area height;

50% means that the height of the bitmap will be half that of the fill area.

Position – Anchor

Point

Click in the position grid to specify an anchor point for the offset for tiling the bitmap.

Position – X offset When Tile is selected, enter a horizontal offset from the anchor point for the bitmap in percentage values.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 143

Option Meaning

Position – Y offset When Tile is selected, enter a vertical offset from the anchor point for the bitmap in percentage values.

Position – Tile

Position – Autofit

Tiles the bitmap to fill the selected object. The size of the bitmap used for the tiling is determined by the Size options.

Stretches the bitmap to fill the selected object. To use Autofit, uncheck the

Tile option. Selecting Autofit disables all size settings.

Offset – Row

Offset – Column

When Tile is selected, offsets the rows of tiled bitmaps by the entered percentage value so that each row is offset from the previous row.

When Tile is selected, offsets the columns of tiled bitmaps by the entered percentage value so that each column is offset from the previous column.

Creating new area fills

The following sections describe how to create new fills and how to apply them.

Although you can change the characteristics of an existing fill and then click the Modify button, it is recommended that you create new fills or modify custom fills rather than the predefined area fills, as these predefined area fills may be reset when updating LibreOffice.

Custom colors

On the Colors page of the Area dialog (Figure 118), you can modify existing colors or create your

own. You can specify a new color either as a combination of the three primary colors Red (R),

Green (G), and Blue (B), (RGB notation) or by percentages of Cyan (C), Magenta (M), Yellow (Y) and Black (K) (CMYK notation).

144

Figure 118: Area dialog – Colors page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Creating new colors

1) Enter a name for the color you want to create in the Name box.

2) Select whether to define the color in RGB or CMYK. For RGB, specify the RGB components on a 0 to 255 scale. For CMYK, specify the CMYK components from 0% to

100%.

3) Click the Add button. The color is now added to the Color drop down list.

Modifying colors

1) Select the color you want to modify from the Color drop down list.

2) Select either RGB or CMYK and enter the new values to define the color.

3) If necessary, type a new name in the Name box.

4) Click Modify and the modified color is saved.

Editing colors

1) Click Edit to open the Color Picker dialog (Figure 119).

2) Modify the color components as required using either RGB, CMYK or HSB (Hue,

Saturation, Brightness) values.

3) Click OK to close the Color Picker dialog.

4) Click the Modify button on the Color dialog.

5) Click OK to save the changes and close the Area dialog.

Figure 119: Color Picker dialog

Saving and using custom colors

Any new color created or modified is available only in the current document. If you want to use this color in other presentations, click the Save Color List icon and type a unique filename in the

Save as dialog that opens. The file created for a list of saved colors has the file extension of .soc.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 145

To use a previously saved color list , click the Load Color List icon and select the file used for a custom color list from the file open dialog. Click Open to load the saved color list into Impress.

Tip

You can also add custom colors using Tools > Options > LibreOffice > Colors. This method makes the color available to all components of LibreOffice. Colors created using the above procedures are only available for Impress.

Custom gradients

On the Gradients page of the Area dialog (Figure 120), you can modify existing gradients or create

your own gradient. Several types of gradients are predefined in LibreOffice and changing the From and To colors could be sufficient to obtain a satisfactory result.

Creating or modifying gradients

1) Select a gradient type from the Type drop down list: Linear, Axial, Radial, Ellipsoid, Square or Rectangular.

2) Alternatively, select one of the predefined gradient types shown in the preview box.

3) Adjust the option settings as necessary. The options used to create a gradient are

summarized in Table 10. Depending on the gradient type selected, some options will not be

available.

4) Click Add to add the newly created gradient to the list.

5) It is recommended to type a memorable name for the new gradient instead of using the default name of Gradient 1, Gradient 2 and so on.

6) Click OK to save the new gradient.

7) Click OK to close the Area dialog.

146

Figure 120: Area dialog – Gradients page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Table 10: Gradient options

Option

Center X

Meaning

For Radial, Ellipsoid, Square and Rectangular gradients, modify these values to set the horizontal offset of the gradient center.

Center Y

For Radial, Ellipsoid, Square and Rectangular gradients, modify these values to set the vertical offset of the gradient center.

Angle

Border

From

To

For all the gradient types, specifies the angle of the gradient axis.

Increase this value to make the gradient start further away from the border of the object.

The start color for the gradient. In the edit box below enter the intensity of the color: 0% corresponds to black, 100% to the full color.

The end color for the gradient. In the edit box below enter the intensity of the color: 0% corresponds to black, 100% to the full color.

Saving and using custom gradients

Any new gradient created or modified is available only in the current document. If you want to use this gradient in other presentations, click the Save Gradients List icon and type a unique filename in the Save as dialog that opens. The file created for a list of saved gradients has the file extension of .sog.

To use a previously saved gradients list, click the Load Gradients List icon and select the file used a custom gradient list from the file open dialog. Click Open to load the saved gradients list into Impress.

Advanced gradient controls

Gradient properties can be configured using the options given in Figure 120 and Table 10. Impress

provides a graphical interface for modifying these gradient options using only the mouse as follows.

1) Select an object that has a gradient and open the Mode toolbar by going to View >

Toolbars > Mode (Figure 121).

Figure 121: Mode toolbar

2) Open the Gradient page of the Area dialog, see “Creating or modifying gradients” above.

3) Click on the Gradient icon in the Mode toolbar to display a dashed line connected to squares at each end of the dashed line. The colors displayed in the two squares show the

From and To colors used for the selected gradient (Figure 122).

4) The gradient used for area fill in the object is adjusted as follows depending on the type of gradient:

Linear gradients – move the square corresponding to the From color to change where the gradient starts (border value). Move the square corresponding to the To color to change the orientation (angle value).

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 147

Axial gradients – only the To color can be moved to change both the angle and border properties of the gradient.

Figure 122: Using mouse to change gradient options

Radial gradients – move the From color to modify the border property to set the width of the gradient circle. Move the To color to change the point where the gradient ends (Center

X and Center Y values).

Ellipsoid gradients – move the From color to modify the border property to set the size of the gradient ellipsoid. Move the To color to change the angle of the ellipsoid axis and the axis itself.

Square and rectangular gradients – move the From color to modify the border to set the size of the gradient square or rectangle and the angle of the gradient shape. Move the To color to change the center of the gradient.

5) When you are satisfied with the changes, click anywhere outside the selected object to deselect it.

Note

Moving the squares will have different effects depending on the type of gradient. For example, for a linear gradient, the start and end squares of the gradient will always be situated to either side of the center point of the object.

Custom hatching patterns

To create new hatching patterns or modify existing hatching patterns, select the Hatching tab of the

Area dialog (Figure 123). The options that can be set for a hatching pattern are explained in Table

11.

Creating or modifying hatching patterns

1) Select one of the predefined gradient types shown in the preview box

2) Modify the options of the lines forming the pattern. A preview is displayed in the window below the available patterns.

3) Click Add to add the newly created hatching pattern to the list.

4) It is recommended to type a memorable name for the new gradient instead of using the default name of Hatching 1, Hatching 2 and so on.

5) Click OK to save the new hatching pattern.

6) Click OK to close the Area dialog.

148 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 123: Area dialog – Hatching page

Table 11: Hatching pattern options

Option Meaning

Spacing Determines the spacing between two lines of the pattern. As the value is changed the preview window is updated.

Angle Use the mini map below the numerical value to quickly set the angle formed by the line to multiples of 45 degrees. If the required angle is not a multiple of

45 degrees, just enter the desired value in the edit box.

Line type

Line color

Set single, double or triple line for the style of the pattern.

Use the list to select the color of the lines that will form the pattern.

Saving and using custom hatching patterns

Any new hatching pattern created or modified is available only in the current document. If you want to use this hatching pattern in other presentations, click the Save Hatches List icon and type a unique filename in the Save as dialog that opens. The file created for a list of saved hatching patterns has the file extension of .soh.

To use a previously saved hatching patterns list, click the Load Hatches List icon and select the file used for a custom hatching patterns list from the file open dialog. Click Open to load the saved hatching patterns list into Impress.

Custom bitmap fills

Creating bitmap fills

1) Select Blank as the bitmap type from the preview list on the Bitmap page of the Area

dialog to activate the Pattern Editor (Figure 124).

2) Select the Foreground and Background colors you want to use for your bitmap from the drop down lists.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 149

Figure 124: Area dialog – Bitmaps page

3) Start creating the pattern by clicking in the squares (pixels) that you want in the foreground color. The background color will automatically fill the grid used for the Pattern Editor when you select the color.

4) Check the preview window to see the effect being achieved as you click the mouse button in a square.

5) When satisfied with your bitmap, click Add to save the bitmap.

6) Enter a memorable name for your bitmap in the Name dialog that opens. It is recommended not to use the default names of Bitmap 1, Bitmap 2 and so on if you want to reuse the bitmap you have just created.

7) Click OK and your bitmap is added to the preview list and is used as an area fill for your selected object.

Modifying bitmaps

Modifying a bitmap that you created creates a copy of the bitmap so that you can edit the bitmap pattern.

1) Select a bitmap pattern that you created from the preview list on the Bitmap page of the

Area dialog (Figure 124).

2) Click Modify and type a new name for the bitmap in the Name dialog that opens.

3) Click OK.

4) Select the newly named bitmap from the preview list and modify the pattern. See "Creating bitmap fills" above for more information.

Importing bitmaps

1) Click Import on the Bitmap page of the Area dialog (Figure 124).

2) Browse to the directory containing the bitmap file you want to import and select it.

3) Click Open and type a name for the imported bitmap.

4) Click OK and your imported bitmap is added to the preview list and is used as an area fill for your selected object.

150 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Note

Bitmaps generally have an extension .bmp or .png. If you create a bitmap image with

Draw, select File > Export, choose PNG from the pull-down list of file formats, give the file a name and save it.

Saving and using custom bitmaps

Any new bitmap created or modified is available only in the current document. If you want to use a custom bitmap in other presentations, click the Save Bitmap List icon and type a unique filename in the Save as dialog that opens. The file created for a list of saved bitmaps has the file extension of .sob.

To use a previously saved hatching patterns list, click the Load Bitmap List icon and select the file used for a bitmaps list from the file open dialog. Click Open to load the saved bitmap list into Impress.

Formatting shadows

Shadows can be applied to objects such as lines, shapes and text. In Impress you can quickly apply a default shadow or apply a customized shadow.

Default shadows

Default shadows use the Impress default settings and cannot be customized.

1) Select the object.

2) Click on the Shadow icon in the Line and Filling toolbar and a shadow is applied to the object.

Customizing shadows

To apply a customized shadow to an object, you have to use the Shadow on the Area dialog.

An alternative method for using customized shadows is to apply a style that uses a shadow See

“Working with graphics styles” on page 156 for additional information on using styles.

1) Select the object and then select Format > Area on the main menu bar, or right click on the object and select Area from the context menu to open the Area dialog.

2) Click on the Shadow tab to open the Shadow page (Figure 125).

Figure 125: Area dialog – Shadow page

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 151

3) Select Use shadow and set the shadow options fas follows:

Position – selects the point determining the direction in which the shadow is cast.

Distance – determines the offset distance between the object and the shadow.

Color – sets the color used for the shadow.

Transparency – determines the amount of transparency for the shadow: 0% opaque shadow, 100% transparent shadow.

4) Click OK and the customized shadow is applied to the object.

Formatting transparencies

Transparencies can be applied to objects and to any shadow that has been applied to an object. In

Impress two types of transparencies can be applied to an object – uniform transparency and gradient transparency. For more information on gradient transparencies, including an example of

combining a color gradient with a gradient transparency, see “Advanced gradient controls” on page

147.

To apply transparencies to lines, refer to “Formatting lines” on page 136 for more information. To

apply transparencies to shadows, refer to “Formatting shadows” on page 151 for more information.

1) Select the object and then select Format > Area on the main menu bar, or right click on the object and select Area from the context menu to open the Area dialog.

2) Click on the Transparency tab to open the Transparency page (Figure 126).

3) To create a uniform transparency, select Transparency and then select the percentage of transparency required.

4) To create a gradient transparency so that the area becomes gradually transparent, select

Gradient and then set the options for the gradient. Refer to Table 12 for a description of the

options available for gradient transparencies.

5) Click OK and the transparency is applied to the object.

152

Figure 126: Area dialog – Transparency page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Table 12: Gradient transparency options

Option

Type

Center X

Center Y

Angle

Border

Start value

End value

Meaning

Select the type of transparency gradient you want to apply.

Radial, Ellipsoid, Quadratic and Square gradients – modify this value to set the horizontal offset of the gradient center.

Radial, Ellipsoid, Quadratic and Square gradients – modify this value to set the vertical offset of the gradient center.

Linear, Axial, Ellipsoid, Quadratic and Square gradient – specifies the angle of the gradient axis.

Increase this value to make the gradient start further away from the border of the object.

Value for the starting transparency gradient. 0% is fully opaque, 100% is fully transparent.

Value for the ending transparency gradient. 0% is fully opaque, 100% is fully transparent.

Formatting text in objects

Impress provides two dialogs related to text formatting on the main menu bar: Format > Character for individual characters and Format > Text for whole words, sentences or paragraphs.

This section only covers the formatting of text which has been added to an object. For more information on formatting text that is used separately on a slide, see Chapter 3 Adding and

Formatting Text.

Adding text to objects

To add text to an object:

1) Select the object to which text will be added so that the selection handles are showing.

2) Double-click on the object and the cursor becomes an I-beam to indicate text mode.

3) Type your text.

4) When finished, click outside of the object or press Esc.

Formatting and editing text in objects

To format text that has been placed into an object:

1) Select the object which contains text.

2) Select the object and go to Format > Text on the main menu bar or right-click on the object

and select Text from the context menu to open the Text dialog (Figure 127).

3) Format and edit the text using the available options. Some options will not be available depending on the type of object to which the text has been added.

Fit width to text – expands the width of the object if the text is too long.

Word wrap text in shape – starts a new line automatically when the edge of the object is reached.

Fit height to text – expands the object height whenever it is smaller than the text (set by default for lines).

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 153

Figure 127: Text dialog

Resize shape to fit text – expands an object when the text inserted in the object is too large.

Fit to frame – expands the text so that it fills all the available space.

Adjust to contour – makes the text follow a curved line.

Spacing to borders – specify the amount of space to be left between the borders of the object and the text. This is similar to setting indentation and spacing for paragraphs.

Text anchor – used to anchor the text to a particular point within the object.

Full width – when selected, anchors the text in the center of the object and uses the full width of the object before wrapping text.

4) Click OK to close the dialog and save the changes to the text.

Text animation

To animate text that has been placed into an object:

1) Select the object which contains text.

2) Select the object and go to Format > Text on the main menu bar or right-click on the object

and select Text from the context menu to open the Text dialog (Figure 127).

3) Click the Text Animation tab to open the Text Animation dialog (Figure 128).

4) Select the type of animation required from the Effects drop down list as follows:

No animation – default setting.

Blink – the text will blink on the screen.

Scroll through – the text will move into the object and then out following the selected direction.

Scroll back and forth – the text will move first in the selected direction, but will bounce back at the object border.

Scroll in – the text will scroll in towards the given direction starting from the edge of the object and stop in the center.

154 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 128: Text animation dialog

5) Set the properties for the animation effect as follows:

Direction – use one of the four arrows to set the scroll direction for the text.

Start inside – animation starts from inside the object.

Text visible when editing select to see the text while editing.

Animation cycles – select Continuous and the text animates continuously or set a specific number of cycles for the animation.

Increment – sets the amount the animation moves in either Pixels or a specific distance.

Units of measurement depend on the settings in Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress >

General.

Delay – sets the delay time either Automatically or a specific length of time before the animation starts.

6) Click OK to close the dialog and save the animation effect.

Formatting connectors

Connectors are lines that join two shapes and always start from or finish at a glue point on an object. Refer to Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects for a description and use of the connectors.

Connectors are formatted as follows:

1) Right-click on a connector and select Connector from the context menu to open the

context dialog (Figure 129).

2) Set the type of connector from the Type drop down list.

3) Set the Line skew for the connector. Line skew is used where multiple connectors overlap to set the distance between the lines. You can customize the distance between three different lines.

4) Set the Line spacing for the connector. Line spacing is used to set the horizontal and vertical space between the connector and the object at each end of the connector.

5) Click OK to close the dialog and save the changes.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 155

Figure 129: Connector dialog

Working with graphics styles

To achieve consistency in styles in slides, or a presentation, or to apply the same formatting to a large number of objects, it is recommended to use a graphics style.

Graphics styles are similar to paragraph styles that are used for text. A graphics style groups all the formatting properties applicable to a graphic object and then associates this group of properties with a name allowing it to be used for other graphic objects. If a graphics style is modified (for example, changing an area transparency), the changes are automatically applied to all objects that use the same graphics style.

If you use Impress frequently, a library of well-defined graphics styles is an invaluable tool for speeding up the process of formatting your work according to any style guidelines you may need to follow (company colors, fonts and so on).

Linked graphics styles

Graphics styles support inheritance which allows a style to be linked to another (parent) style so that it inherits all the formatting settings of the parent. This inheritance creates families of styles.

For example, if you require multiple boxes that differ in color, but are otherwise identically formatted, the best way to proceed is to define a generic style for the box including borders, area fill, font, and so on and a number of hierarchically dependent styles which differ only in the fill color attribute. If you need to change the font size or the thickness of the border, you only have to change the parent style and all the other styles will change accordingly.

Creating graphics styles

You can create a new graphics style either by using the Style and Formatting dialog or from a selection.

Using the Styles and Formatting dialog

1) Select a graphic object.

156 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

2) Press the F11 key, or click on the Styles and Formatting icon on the Line and Filling toolbar, or select Format > Styles and Formatting on the main menu bar to open the

Styles and Formatting dialog (Figure 130).

Figure 130: Graphics Styles and Formatting

3) Click on the Graphics Styles icon on the to access graphic styles.

4) Select the style similar to the one you want to use in the Styles and Formatting dialog.

5) Right click and select New from the context menu to open the Graphics Styles dialog

(Figure 131). By default, this will link the selected graphics style with the new graphics

style.

6) To create a graphics style without linking, select None from the Linked with drop down menu on the Organizer page.

7) Give your new graphics style a memorable name.

8) Use the various tabs and text boxes in the Graphics Styles dialog to format and categorize your new style as follows:

Organizer – contains a summary of the style and its hierarchical position.

Font, Font Effects, Indents & Spacing, Alignment, Tabs and Asian Typography – set the properties of the text inserted in a graphic object.

Dimensioning – used to set the style of dimension lines.

Text, Text Animation, Connector, Line, Area, Shadowing, and Transparency – determine the formatting of a graphic object and are discussed elsewhere in this chapter.

9) Click OK when finished to save your new graphics style.

Note

When styles are linked, changing the font for example will change the font in all linked styles. Sometimes this is exactly what you want; at other times you do not want the changes to apply to all linked styles. It pays to plan ahead.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 157

Figure 131: Graphics Styles dialog

From a selected object

You can create a new style from an object that has already been formatted. This can be text or graphics:

1) Select the object you want to use to create your new style.

2) Open the Styles and Formatting dialog and click the New Style from Selection icon .

3) In the Create Style dialog (Figure 132) that opens type a name for the new style. The list

shows existing custom styles of that are available.

4) Click OK to save the new style.

Figure 132: Naming a new style created from a selection

Modifying a graphics style

1) Open the Styles and Formatting dialog.

2) Right-click on the style you want to modify and select Modify from the context menu to

open the Graphics Style dialog (Figure 131).

3) Make the required changes to the style and then click OK to save the changes.

Updating a graphics style from a selection

To update a style from changes you have made to a selected object:

1) Select an object that uses the format you want to adopt as a style.

2) Open the Styles and Formatting dialog and select the style you want to update.

3) Click the Update Style icon and the style is updated with your changes.

Tip

Any changes you make to a style are effective only in the document on which you are working and do not go into change the associated template. If you want the changes to apply to more than one document, you need to change the template (see Chapter

2 Using Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates for more information).

158 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Applying graphics styles

Use the following steps to apply a graphics style to an object.

1) Open the Styles and Formatting dialog (Figure 130) and click on the Graphics Styles icon

on the to access graphic styles.

2) Select the object to which you want to apply a graphics style.

3) Double-click on the name of the style you want to apply.

4) Alternatively, click on the Fill Format Mode icon and the cursor changes to this icon.

5) Position the icon on the graphic object to be styled and click the mouse button. This mode remains active until you turn it off, so you can apply the same style to several objects.

6) To quit Fill Format mode, click the Fill Format mode icon again or press the Esc key.

Note

When Fill Format mode is active, a right-click anywhere in the document cancels the last Fill Format action. Take care not to accidentally right-click and undo any actions you want to keep.

Tip

At the bottom of the Styles and Formatting window is a drop-down list. You can choose to show all styles or groups of styles such as applied styles or (in the case of graphics styles) custom styles.

Deleting graphics styles

You cannot delete any of the predefined styles in Impress, even if you are not using them. You can only delete user-defined (custom) styles. However, before you delete a custom style, make sure the style is not in use. If an unwanted style is in use, replace it with a substitute style.

1) Open the Styles and Formatting dialog (Figure 130) and click on the Graphics Styles icon

on the to access graphic styles.

2) Right-click on a custom graphic style and click Delete on the context menu. You can only delete one custom graphics style at a time.

3) Click Yes to confirm the deletion of the graphics style.

Assigning styles to shortcut keys

LibreOffice provides a set of predefined keyboard shortcuts which allow you to quickly apply styles while working with a document. You can redefine these shortcuts or define your own, as described in Appendix A Keyboard Shortcuts.

Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects 159

Chapter

7

Including Spreadsheets,

Charts, and Other Objects

OLE objects

Object Linking and Embedding (OLE) is a software technology that allows embedding and linking of the following types of files or documents into an Impress presentation.

LibreOffice spreadsheets

LibreOffice charts

LibreOffice drawings

LibreOffice formulas

LibreOffice text

The major benefit of using OLE objects is that it provides a quick and easy method of editing the object using tools from the software used to create the object. These file types can all be created using LibreOffice and OLE objects can be created from new or from an existing file.

Inserting new OLE objects

When you insert a new OLE object into your presentation, it is only available in your presentation and can only be edited using Impress.

Figure 133: Inserting a new OLE object

To add a new OLE object into your presentation:

1) Go to the slide where you want to insert the OLE object.

2) Select Insert > Object > OLE Object from the menu bar.

3) On the Insert OLE Object dialog (Figure 133), select Create new.

4) Select the type of OLE object you want to create and click OK.

5) A new OLE object is inserted in the center of the slide in edit mode. The toolbars displayed in Impress will change providing the necessary tools for you to create the new OLE object.

Note

For computers operating Microsoft Windows there is an additional option of Further

objects in the Object type list. Clicking on this option opens an Insert Object dialog allowing you to create an OLE object using other software that is compatible with

OLE and LibreOffice. This option is available for new OLE objects and OLE objects from a file.

162 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Inserting OLE objects from files

When you insert an existing file into your slide as an OLE object, by default any subsequent changes that are made to the original file do not affect the copy of the file inserted into your presentation. Similarly, changes to the file copy in your presentation do not change the original file.

If you want any changes made to the file, either in the original or in your presentation, to appear in both versions you have to link the original file with your presentation when it is inserted.

Figure 134: Inserting an OLE object from file

To insert a file into your presentation as an OLE object:

1) Go to the slide where you want to insert the spreadsheet.

2) Choose Insert > Object > OLE Object from the menu bar.

3) On the Insert OLE Object dialog, select Create from file. The dialog changes to show a

File text box (Figure 134).

4) Click Search and the Open dialog is displayed.

5) Locate the file you want to insert and click Open.

6) Select the Link to file option if you wish to insert the file as a live link so that any changes made are synchronized in both the original file and your presentation.

7) Click OK to insert the file as an OLE object.

Editing OLE objects

To edit an OLE object after it has been created or inserted from a file:

1) Double-click on the OLE object to open it in edit mode (Figure 135). The toolbars displayed

in Impress will change to provide the tools necessary to edit the OLE object (Figure 136).

2) When finished editing the OLE object, click anywhere outside the OLE object to cancel editing.

3) Save your presentation. Any changes made to the OLE object are also saved.

Figure 135: Example OLE object in edit mode

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 163

Figure 136: Example toolbars for OLE object editing

Spreadsheets

To include a spreadsheet in an Impress slide, you can either insert an existing spreadsheet file or

insert a new spreadsheet as an OLE object. See “Inserting new OLE objects” on page 162 for

more information.

Embedding a spreadsheet into Impress includes most of the functionality of a Calc spreadsheet.

Impress is capable of performing complex calculations and data analysis. However, if you plan to use complex data or formulas, it is recommended to perform those operations in a separate Calc spreadsheet and use Impress only to display the embedded spreadsheet with the results.

You may be tempted to use spreadsheets in Impress for creating complex tables or presenting data in a tabular format. However, the Table Design feature in Impress is often more suitable and faster, depending on the complexity of your data; see Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text for more information.

The entire spreadsheet is inserted into your slide. If the spreadsheet contains more than one sheet and the one you want is not visible, double-click the spreadsheet and then select a different sheet from the row of sheet tabs at the bottom.

Resizing and moving spreadsheets

When resizing or moving a spreadsheet on slides, ignore the first row and first column (easily recognizable because of their light background color) and any horizontal and vertical scroll bars.

They are only used for spreadsheet editing purposes and will not be included in the spreadsheet that appears on the slide.

Resizing

When selected, a spreadsheet OLE object is treated like any other object. However, resizing an embedded spreadsheet also changes the spreadsheet area that is visible on a slide.

To resize the area occupied by the spreadsheet on a slide:

1) Double-click the OLE object to enter edit mode, if it is not already active. Note the selection

handles visible in the border surrounding the spreadsheet OLE object (Figure 135).

2) Move the mouse over one of the handles. The cursor changes shape to give a visual representation of the effects applied to the area.

3) Click and hold the left mouse button and drag the handle. The corner handles move the two adjacent sides simultaneously, while the handles at the midpoint of the sides modify one dimension at a time.

Moving

You can move a spreadsheet OLE object (change its position within the slide) when it is in edit mode.

1) Move the mouse over the object border until the cursor changes shape (normally a hand, but this depends on your computer setup).

2) Click and hold the left mouse button and drag the spreadsheet to the desired position.

3) Release the mouse button.

164 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Editing spreadsheets

When a spreadsheet is inserted into a slide, it is in edit mode ready for inserting or modifying data

or modifying the format (example shown in Figure 135). Note the position of the active spreadsheet

cell and the small resizing handles on the object border.

When editing a spreadsheet, some of the toolbars change in Impress so that you can easily edit a

spreadsheet (Figure 136). One of the most important changes is the presence of the Formula

toolbar, just below the Formatting toolbar. The Formula toolbar contains (from left to right):

The active cell reference or the name of a selected range of cells.

The Formula Wizard icon .

The Sum and Function icons or the Cancel and Accept icons, depending on the editing actions taken in the spreadsheet.

A long edit box to enter or review the contents of the active cell.

If you are familiar with Calc, you will immediately recognize the tools and the menu items. See the

Calc Guide for more information on how to create and edit spreadsheets in LibreOffice.

Spreadsheet organization

A spreadsheet consists of multiple tables called sheets, which in turn contain cells. However, in

Impress, only one sheet can be shown at any one time in a slide when a spreadsheet with multiple sheets is embedded into an Impress slide. The default names for sheets are Sheet 1, Sheet 2,

Sheet 3 and so on, unless the sheets have been renamed, and the sheet names are shown at the

bottom of the spreadsheet area (Figure 135).

Each sheet is organized into cells, which are the elementary units of the spreadsheet. They are identified by a row number (shown on the left hand side) and a column letter (shown in the top row). For example, the top left cell is identified as A1, while the third cell in the second row is C2.

All data elements, whether text, numbers or formulas, are entered into a cell.

Note

If you have multiple sheets in your embedded spreadsheet, only the active sheet is shown on the slide after exiting edit mode.

Figure 137: Insert Sheet dialog

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 165

Inserting sheets

If required, you can insert sheets to your embedded spreadsheet as follows:

1) Double-click on the embedded spreadsheet to open in edit mode (Figure 135).

2) Right-click on the sheet names and select Insert > Sheet from the context menu, or click on the plus sign to the right of the sheet names, or go to Insert > Sheet on the main menu

bar to open the Insert Sheet dialog (Figure 137).

3) Select the sheet position, quantity of sheets to be inserted, sheet name or which spreadsheet file to use from the options available in the Insert Sheet dialog.

4) Click OK to close the dialog and insert the sheet.

5) When finished editing the embedded spreadsheet, click anywhere outside the border to cancel edit mode and save the changes.

Renaming sheets

If required, you can rename sheets in your embedded spreadsheet as follows:

1) Double-click on the embedded spreadsheet to open in edit mode (Figure 135).

2) Click on the sheet tab you want to rename to select the sheet.

3) Right-click on the sheet tab and select Rename Sheet from the context menu, or go to

Format > Sheet > Rename on the main menu bar.

4) When finished editing the embedded spreadsheet, click anywhere outside the border to cancel edit mode and save the changes.

Moving and copying sheets

If required, you can move or copy sheets in your embedded spreadsheet as follows:

1) Double-click on the embedded spreadsheet to open in edit mode (Figure 135).

166

Figure 138: Move/Copy Sheet dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

2) Right-click on the sheet names and select Move/Copy Sheet from the context menu, or go to Edit > Sheet > Move/Copy on the main menu bar to open the Move/Copy Sheet dialog

(Figure 138).

3) Select whether to move or copy the sheet, the sheet location and position, and a new sheet name from the options available in the Move/Copy Sheet dialog.

4) Click OK to close the dialog and move or copy the sheet.

5) Alternatively, click on the sheet tab and drag it to a new position in the embedded spreadsheet.

6) When finished editing the embedded spreadsheet, click anywhere outside the border to cancel edit mode and save the changes.

Deleting sheets

If required, you can delete sheets and remove them from your embedded spreadsheet as follows:

1) Double-click on the embedded spreadsheet to open in edit mode (Figure 135).

2) Click on the sheet tab you want to delete to select the sheet.

3) Right-click on the sheet tab and select Delete Sheet from the context menu, or go to Edit >

Sheet > Delete on the main menu bar.

4) Click Yes to confirm the deletion of the sheet.

5) When finished editing the embedded spreadsheet, click anywhere outside the border to cancel edit mode and save the changes.

Cell navigation

To move around the spreadsheet to select a cell to make it active, you can use one of the following methods. By default when open an embedded spreadsheet in Impress, the active cell is A1:

The keyboard arrow keys.

Position the cursor in a cell and left click on the mouse.

Enter key to move one cell down and Shift+Enter key combination to move one cell up.

Tab key to move one cell to the right and Shift+Tab key combination to move one cell to the left.

Note

Other keyboard shortcuts are available to navigate around a spreadsheet. Refer to

Getting Started Guide Chapter 5 Getting Started with Calc for more information.

Entering data

Data input into a cell can only be done when a cell is active. An active cell is easily identified by a thickened and bolder border. The cell reference (or coordinates) for the active cell is displayed at

the left hand end of the Formula toolbar (Figure 136).

1) Select the cell to make it active and start typing. The data input is also displayed in the large text box on the Formula toolbar making the data entry easier to read.

2) Use the Formula Wizard icon , Sum icon and Function icon to enter data, formula or function into a cell. If the input is not a formula (for example, a text or date entry), the Sum and Function icons change to the Cancel icon and Accept icon .

3) To confirm data input into a cell either select a different cell, or press the Enter key, or click on the Accept icon.

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 167

Formatting cell data

Impress normally recognizes the type of contents (text, number, date, time, and so on) entered into a cell and applies default formatting to it. However, if Impress wrongly recognizes the type of data you have entered into a cell:

1) Select the cell then right-click on the cell and select Format Cells from the context menu, or go to Format > Cells on the main menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+1 to open

the Format Cells dialog (Figure 139).

2) Click on the Numbers tab and use the options on this dialog page to format the cell data.

3) Click OK to close the dialog and save your changes.

Tip

Sometimes it is useful to treat numbers as text (for example, telephone numbers) and to prevent Impress from removing the leading zeros or right align them in a cell. To force Impress to treat numbers as text, type a single quotation mark (') before entering the number.

Figure 139: Formatting Cells dialog

Formatting spreadsheets

For presentation purposes, it may be necessary to change the formatting of a spreadsheet to match the style used in the presentation.

When working on an embedded spreadsheet, you can also access any cell styles created in Calc and use them. However, if you are going to use styles, it is recommended to create specific cell styles for embedded spreadsheets, as Calc cell styles maybe unsuitable when working within

Impress.

Manual formatting

To manually format an embedded spreadsheet:

1) Select a cell or a range of cells. See the Getting Started Guide Chapter 5 Getting Started

with Calc for more information on selecting ranges of cells.

168 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

To select the whole sheet, click on the blank cell at the top left corner between the row and column indexes, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+A.

To select a column, click on the column header at the top of the spreadsheet.

To select a row, click on the row header on the left hand side of the spreadsheet.

2) Right-click on a cell and select Format Cells from the context menu, or go to Format >

Cells on the main menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+1 to open the Format Cells

dialog (Figure 139).

3) Use the various dialog pages to format the embedded spreadsheet so that it matches the style of your presentation.

4) Click OK to close the dialog and save your changes.

5) If necessary, adjust the column width by hovering the mouse over the line separating two columns in the header row until the mouse cursor changes to a double-headed arrow; then click the left button and drag the separating line to the new position.

6) If necessary, adjust the row height by hovering the mouse over the line separating two rows in the row header until the mouse cursor changes to a double-headed arrow; then click the left button and drag the separating line to the new position.

7) When you are satisfied with the formatting changes, click outside the spreadsheet area to save your changes and cancel editing.

Using formatting styles

When using styles on an embedded spreadsheet and the spreadsheet is in edit mode, Impress displays the available styles for a spreadsheet in the Styles and Formatting dialog.

If style formatting you want to use is not available, then see the Writer Guide Chapter 6

Introduction to Styles on how to create a style. Styles used in an embedded spreadsheet are similar to paragraph styles used in LibreOffice Writer.

To use styles in your embedded spreadsheet:

1) Go to Format > Styles and Formatting on the main menu bar or press the F11 key to open the Styles and Formatting dialog.

2) Select data in a cell and double-click on a style in the Styles and Formatting dialog to apply that style.

Inserting rows, columns or cells

To insert rows, columns, or cells into an embedded spreadsheet:

1) Select the same number of rows, columns or cells on the embedded spreadsheet that you want to insert.

2) Go to Insert > Rows or Insert > Columns or Insert > Cells on the main menu bar or rightclick on your selection and select Insert Rows or Insert Columns or Insert... from the context menu.

3) When inserting cells, select the insert option from the Insert Cells dialog that opens and click OK.

Deleting rows, columns or cells

To delete rows, columns or cells from an embedded spreadsheet:

1) Highlight the number of rows, columns or cells on the embedded spreadsheet you want to delete.

2) Go to Edit > Delete Cells on the main menu bar or right-click on the row or column headers and select Delete Rows or Delete Columns or Delete... from the context menu.

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 169

Merging cells

To merge multiple cells into a single cell:

1) Select the number cells to be merged.

2) Go to Format > Merge cells on the main menu bar and select either Merge and Center

Cells or Merge Cells from the available options.

3) Alternatively, right-click on the selected cells and select Merge Cells from the context menu.

Splitting cells

To split a group of cells that have been merged into a single cell:

1) Select the cell that contains merged cells.

2) Go to Format > Merge Cells > Split Cells or right-click on the cell and select Split Cells from the context menu.

Charts

A chart is a graphical interpretation of information that is contained in a spreadsheet. More information about charts and the use of charts is described the Calc Guide Chapter 3 Creating

Charts and Graphs.

Inserting charts

You can insert a chart to your presentation as an OLE object or using the tools within Impress. See

“Inserting new OLE objects” on page 162 for more information on how to insert a chart as an OLE

object.

To insert a chart using Impress tools:

1) Go to Insert > Slide on the main menu bar, or right-click on the Workspace and select

Slide > New Slide from the context menu, or right-click on the Slides pane and select New

Slide from the context menu to insert a new slide into your presentation.

170

Figure 140: Inserting objects into a slide

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 141: Chart with sample data

2) Select the Insert Chart icon on the new slide (Figure 140), or use Insert > Chart on the

main menu bar, or click the Chart icon on the Standard toolbar and a sample chart is

inserted into the slide containing sample data (Figure 141). To change chart type, see

“Selecting chart type” below and to enter data into the chart, see “Entering chart data” on page 173.

Selecting chart type

Your data can be presented using a variety of different charts. Impress contains several chart types

that will help you convey your message to your audience. See “Chart types” on page 172 for an

explanation of the different chart types available.

1) Make sure that your chart is selected. The chart has a border and selection handles when selected.

2) Click the Chart Type icon on the Formatting toolbar or go to Format > Chart Type on the main menu bar, or right-click on the chart and select Chart Type from the context menu

to open Chart Type dialog (Figure 142).

Figure 142: Chart Type dialog showing two-dimensional charts

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 171

3) As you change selections in the left-hand list, the chart examples on the right change. If you move the Chart Type dialog to one side, you can see the effect in your chart.

4) As you change chart types, other selections become available on the right-hand side. For example, some chart types have both 3D and 2D variants. When 3D charts are selected, more options become available for selection of shapes for the columns or bars.

5) Choose the chart characteristics you want and click OK. The Chart Type dialog closes and you return to the edit window.

6) Continue to format the chart, add data to the chart, or click outside the chart to return to normal view.

Chart types

The following summary of the chart types available will help you choose a type suitable for your data. Column, bar, pie and area charts are available as 2D or 3D types. For more information on charts, see the Calc Guide Chapter 3 Creating Charts and Graphs.

Column charts

Column charts displays data that shows trends over time and this the default type of chart used when a chart is inserted into your slide. It is recommended to use column charts where there is a relatively small number of data points. If you have a large time series as your data, it is recommended to use a line chart.

Bar charts

Bar charts give an immediate visual impact for data comparison where time is not important, for example comparing the popularity of products in a marketplace.

Pie charts

Pie charts give a comparison of proportions, for example, when comparing what different departments spent on different items or what different departments actually spent overall. They work best with a small range of values, for example six or less. Using larger range of values, the visual impact of a pie chart begins to fade.

Area charts

Area charts are versions of line or column charts. They are useful when you want to emphasize volume of change. Area charts have a greater visual impact than a line chart, but the type of data you use does make a difference to the visual impact.

Line charts

Line charts are time series with progression. Ideal for raw data and useful for charts with data showing trends or changes over time where you want to emphasize continuity. On line charts, the X-axis is ideal for representing time series data. 3D lines confuse the viewer, so just using a thicker line gives a better visual impact.

Scatter or XY charts

Scatter charts are great for visualizing data that you have not had time to analyze and may be best for data where you have a constant value for comparison: for example weather data, reactions under different acidity levels, conditions at altitude, or any data which matches two numeric series. The X-axis usually plots the independent variable or control parameter (often a time series).

Bubble charts

Bubble charts are used to represent three variables. Two variables identify the position of the center of a bubble on a Cartesian graph, while the third variable indicates the radius of the bubble.

172 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Net charts

Net charts are similar to polar or radar graphs and are useful for comparing data not in time series, but show different circumstances, such as variables in a scientific experiment. The poles of the net chart are the Y-axes of other charts. Generally, between three and eight axes are best; any more and this type of chart becomes confusing.

Stock charts

Stock charts are specialized column graphs specifically used for stocks and shares. You can choose traditional lines, candlestick, and two-column charts. The data required for these charts is specialized with a series for opening price, closing price, and high and low prices. The X-axis represents a time series.

Column and line charts

Column and line charts are a combination of two other chart types. It is useful for combining two distinct, but related data series, for example sales over time (column) and the profit margin trends (line).

Entering chart data

1) Make sure that your chart is selected and you have selected your chart type.

2) Click on the Chart Data Table icon , or select View > Chart Data Table, or right-click on the chart and select Chart Data Table from the context menu to open the Data Table

dialog (Figure 143).

3) Type or paste information into the cells within the desired rows and columns to enter data into the Data Table dialog. You can also use the icons in the top left corner of the Data

Table dialog to insert, delete or move data.

Figure 143: Chart Data Table dialog

Adding or removing chart elements

The specimen chart inserted into a slide only includes two elements: a chart wall and a chart legend (also known as the key). You can add or remove elements to or from a chart as follows:

1) Make sure the chart is selected and in edit mode.

2) Go to Insert on the main menu bar and select from the submenu an element that you want to add to the chart, or right-click on the chart wall or a chart element and select an element you want to add from the context menu. Selecting an element opens a dialog where you can specify options for the element.

Note

Right-clicking on a chart element will give you more options to choose from when adding elements to your chart. The number of available insert options in the context menu depends on the type of element selected.

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 173

3) To remove an element from a chart, right-click on the chart element you want to remove and select the Delete option from the context menu. The type of element selected for removal will change the delete options in the context menu.

4) Select a chart element and press the Del or Backspace (←) key to remove it from your chart.

Chart formatting

To change the format of a selected chart:

1) Make sure the chart is selected and in edit mode.

2) Go to Format on the main menu bar and select from the submenu an element that you want to format, or right-click on a chart element and select a format option from the context menu. Selecting an element opens a dialog where you can specify format options for the element.

The formatting options available depend on whether the whole chart is selected or which chart element has been selected. For more information on chart formatting, see the Calc Guide Chapter

3 Creating Charts and Graphs.

Resizing and moving charts

You can resize or move a chart interactively or by using the Position and Size dialog. You can also use a combination of both methods.

Resizing

To resize a chart interactively:

1) Click on a chart to select it and selection handles appear around the chart.

2) To increase or decrease the height of a chart, click and drag on a selection handle at the top or bottom of the chart.

3) To increase or decrease the width of a chart, click and drag on a selection handle at the left or right of the chart.

4) To increase or decrease both the height and width of a chart at the same time , click and drag on a selection handle in one of the corners of the chart. To maintain the correct aspect ratio between height and width, hold the Shift key down while you click and drag.

Moving

To move a chart interactively:

1) Click on the chart to select it and selection handles appear around the chart.

2) Move the cursor anywhere on the chart other than on a selection handle.

3) When it changes shape, click and drag the chart to its new location.

4) Release the mouse button when the chart is in the desired position.

Position and Size dialog

To resize or move a chart using the Position and Size dialog box:

1) Click on the chart to select it and selection handles appear around the chart.

2) Go to Format > Position and Size on the menu bar, or right-click on the chart and select

Position and Size from the context menu, or press F4 key to open the Position and Size

dialog (Figure 144). For more information on the Position and Size dialog and how to use,

see Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects.

174 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 144: Position and Size dialog

Chart elements

You can move or resize individual elements of a chart element independently of other chart elements. For example, you can move the chart legend to a different position. Pie charts allow individual wedges of the pie to be moved as well as “exploding” the entire pie.

1) Double-click the chart so that it is in edit mode.

2) Click any chart element to select it. Selection handles appear.

3) Move the cursor over the selected element and when the cursor changes shape, click and drag to move the element.

4) Release the mouse button when the element is in the desired position.

Note

If your chart is 3D, round selection handles appear; these control the threedimensional angle of the chart. You cannot resize or reposition the chart while the round selection handles are showing. Shift + Click to get back to the square resizing handles. You can now resize and reposition your 3D chart.

Changing chart area background

The chart area is the area surrounding the chart graphic and includes the (optional) main title and key.

1) Double-click the chart so that it is in edit mode.

2) Go to Format > Format Selection on the main menu bar, or right-click in the chart area and select Format Chart Area, or double-click in the chart area to open the Chart Area

dialog (Figure 145).

3) Click on the Area tab to open the page containing the area options.

4) Select from the Fill drop down list the type of background fill you want to use. The available options will change depending on the type of fill selected.

5) Click OK to close the dialog and save your changes.

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 175

Figure 145: Chart Area dialog

Changing chart wall background

The chart wall is the area that contains the chart graphic.

1) Double-click the chart so that it is in edit mode.

2) Select Format > Format Selection on the main menu bar, or right-click in the chart wall and select Format Wall, or double-click in the chart wall to open the Chart Wall dialog.

3) Select the Area tab from the dialog that opens. This dialog has the same formatting options

as described in “Changing chart area background” above.

4) Click OK to close the dialog and save your changes.

Movies and sound

Using media files

To insert a media file into your presentation:

1) Click the Insert Movie icon on the slide layout (Figure 140) or go to Insert > Movie and

Sound on the menu bar to open the Insert Movie and Sound dialog (Figure 146).

2) Select the media file to insert and click Open to place the object on the slide.

Note

Any media file will start playing as soon as the slide is shown during the presentation.

Tip

To see a list of audio and video file types supported by Impress, open the drop-down list of file types. This list defaults to All movie and sound files, enabling you to choose unsupported files such as .MOV.

176 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 146: Insert Movie and Sound dialog

Impress only links media files and does not embed a media file into a presentation. Therefore if a presentation is moved to a different computer, any links will be broken and the media files will not play. To prevent this from happening:

1) Place any media files which are included in a presentation in the same folder where the presentation is stored.

2) Insert the media file in the presentation.

3) Send both the presentation and any media files to the computer which is to be used for the presentation and place both files in the same folder on that computer.

Using the Gallery

To insert media clips directly from the Gallery:

1) If the Gallery is not already open, choose Tools > Gallery from the menu bar.

2) Browse to a theme containing media files (for example Sounds).

3) Click on the movie or sound to be inserted and drag it into the slide area.

Figure 147: Media playback toolbar

Media playback

The Media Playback toolbar (Figure 147) is automatically opened when a media file is selected.

The default position of the toolbar is at the bottom of the screen, just above the Drawing toolbar.

However, this toolbar can be undocked from its fixed position and allowed to float on screen. If the toolbar does not open, go to View > Toolbars > Media Playback on the main menu bar.

Chapter 7 Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects 177

The Media Playback toolbar contains the following tools from left to right:

Movie and Sound – opens the Insert Movie and Sound dialog where you can select a media file to be inserted.

Play, Pause, Stop – controls media playback.

Repeat – if selected, media will continuously repeat playing until this tool is de-selected.

Playback slider – selects the position to start playing from within the media file.

Timer – displays current position of the media clip and length of media file.

Mute – when selected, the sound will be suppressed.

Volume slider – adjusts the volume of the media file.

Scaling drop-down menu – only available for movies and allows scaling of the movie clip.

Media player

Impress also has a media player so that you can preview any media files that are to be inserted into a presentation. To open it select Tools > Media Player on the main menu bar and its tools are

the same as that of the Media Playback toolbar (Figure 147).

Formulas

Go to Insert > Object > Formula on the main menu bar to create a formula (Math object) in a

slide. A formula can also be inserted as an OLE object; see “Inserting new OLE objects” on page

162 for more information.

When editing a formula, the Math menu becomes available allowing you to create or edit a formula.

When creating formulas, care should be taken about font sizes used to make sure they are similar in size to the font size used in the presentation. To change font attributes of a Math object, go to

Format > Font Size on the main menu bar. To change font type, go to Format > Fonts on the main menu bar.

For information on how to create formulas, see the Getting Started Guide Chapter 9 Getting

Started with Math or the Math Guide.

Note

Unlike formulas in Writer, a formula in Impress is treated as an object and will not be automatically aligned with the rest of the objects on the slide. The formula can be moved around like any other object but cannot be resized.

Drawings, text files, HTML files and other objects

You can insert into a presentation drawings, text files, HTML files and other objects, but only if these objects are compatible for insertion into an Impress presentation.

Go to Insert > File on the main menu bar to open a file selection dialog. Only files compatible with

Impress will be available for selection.

Drawings, text files, HTML files and other objects can also be inserted as OLE objects; see

“Inserting new OLE objects” on page 162 for more information.

Note

For computers operating Microsoft Windows there is an additional option of

Further objects. Clicking on this option opens an Insert Object dialog allowing you to create an OLE object using software that is compatible with OLE standards.

178 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Chapter

8

Adding and Formatting Slides,

Notes, and Handouts

Introduction

This chapter describes how to add new slides to the presentation and how to format slides, notes and handouts. Notes are generally used as prompts for the person giving the presentation.

Handouts are normally used for providing a printout of the slides to your audience.

Adding, renaming, and removing slides

Two context menus are available for use when performing operations on slides. One slide context menu is displayed by right-clicking on a slide in the Workspace Normal view and then selecting

Slide (Figure 148). The other slide context menu is accessed by right-clicking on a slide thumbnail in the Slides pane (Figure 149).

Figure 148: Workspace slide context menu

Figure 149: Slide pane context menu

Adding new slides

A new slide is inserted after the current slide or in the position where the mouse was clicked. If multiple slide masters have been used in a presentation, the new slide will use the master of the previous slide in the presentation sequence.

You can add a new slide to a presentation as follows:

1) In Normal, Outline, or Slide Sorter view, go to Insert > Slide on the main menu bar.

2) In Normal, Outline, or Notes view, right-click on the Slides pane and select New Slide from the context menu.

180 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

3) In Slide Sorter view, right click in the main work area and select New Slide from the context menu.

4) In Normal view, right-click in the Workspace and select Slide > New Slide from the context menu.

Inserting slides from another presentation

Inserting from file

Figure 150: Insert Slides/Objects dialog

1) In Normal view, select the slide in your presentation before the point where you want to insert the new slide.

2) Go to Insert > File on the main menu bar to open the Insert File dialog.

3) In the Insert File dialog, locate and select the file containing the slide that you want to insert

and click Open. This opens the Insert Slides/Objects dialog (Figure 150).

4) Click on the small triangular icon next to the filename to expand the list of slides.

5) Select the slides that you want to insert into your presentation.

6) If required, select the Link option to embed the slides as OLE objects.

7) Click OK. The slides are inserted after the selected slide in the presentation.

Note

When inserting from a file, you can optionally link the slides instead of copying. This embeds the slides into your presentation using OLE. See Chapter 7 Including

Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects for more information about OLE.

Tip

Figure 150 shows the importance of giving descriptive names to slides in a

presentation. Refer to “Renaming slides on page 183 for more information.

Copying and pasting between presentations

1) Open the presentations that you want to copy from and paste into.

2) In the presentation containing the slides that you want to copy from, go to View > Slide

Sorter on the main menu bar or click on the Slide Sorter tab in the Workspace so that you can easily locate the slides you want to copy.

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 181

3) Select the slides you require and go to Edit > Copy on the main menu, or right click and select Copy on the context menu, or click the Copy icon on the Standard toolbar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+C and the selected slides are copied.

4) Go to the presentation where you want to paste the slides and select View > Normal or

View > Slide Sorter on the main menu bar, click on the Normal tab or Slide Sorter tab in the Workspace.

5) Select the slide at the point where you want to insert the copied slides after.

6) Go to Edit > Paste on the main menu bar, or right click and select Paste on the context menu, or click the Paste icon on the Standard toolbar, or use the keyboard shortcut

Ctrl+V and the copied slides are pasted into your presentation.

Dragging and dropping between presentations

1) Open both presentations that you want to use to move or copy slides between and arrange the windows so both presentations are visible.

2) On both presentations, go to View > Slide Sorter on the main menu bar or click on the

Slide Sorter tab in the Workspace.

3) In the presentation containing the slides that you want to move or copy, select the required slides.

4) To move the slides, click and hold down the left mouse button to drag and drop the selected slides into the target presentation.

5) To copy the slides, hold down the Ctrl key while dragging and dropping to copy the selected slides into the target presentation.

Duplicating slides

Duplicating a slide is an easy way to add slides if you want a new slide to inherit formatting, layout and animations from a selected slide. To duplicate a slide:

1) Click on the Normal tab or Slide Sorter tab in the Workspace or go to View > Normal or

View > Slide Sorter on the main menu bar.

2) Select the slide you want to duplicate.

3) Go to Insert > Duplicate Slide on the main menu, or right click and select Duplicate Slide on the context menu. The duplicated slide is inserted after the original slide.

Tip

Duplicating a slide is a good way of preventing slides being shown with too much information making it difficult for your audience to understand. If a slide becomes crowded with information, try duplicating a “busy” slide then split the information points over two or more slides. All the formatting, backgrounds, and so on will be preserved in each duplicated slide.

Figure 151: Rename Slide dialog

182 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Renaming slides

Renaming a slide is as follows:

1) Click on the Normal tab or Slide Sorter tab in the Workspace or go to View > Normal or

View > Slide Sorter on the main menu bar.

2) In Normal view, right-click on the slide in the Slides pane or Workspace and select Slide >

Rename Slide from the context menu.

3) In Slide Sorter view, right-click on the slide and select Rename Slide from the context menu.

4) In the Rename Slide dialog (Figure 151), type a new name for the slide and click OK.

Expanding slides

Occasionally you may have a slide with too many points to fit in the space available. Instead of reducing the font size or using other methods to squeeze more text onto the slide, it is better to subdivide the contents of the slide into two or more slides.

As mentioned in “Duplicating slides” on page 182, you can duplicate the slide and manually split

the points. Alternatively the contents of a slide can be expanded as follows:

1) If necessary, duplicate the slide in case of error and you want to redo expansion of the slide.

2) Select Insert > Expand Slide from the main menu to create a new slide for each highest level of the outline. The outline text becomes the title of each new slide. Outline points below the top level on the original slide are moved up one level in the new slides.

3) If required, repeat steps 2 and 3 on any slide where level 2 entries of the outline exist, to expand those as well.

Figure 152 shows a slide with an outline that has been expanded using the Expand Slide

command. Each expanded slide has been given the slide title of each of the second level points on the original slide.

Note

Figure 152: Original slide expanded

For the Expand command to work, ensure that the slide layout contains only one text

AutoLayout box. If the layout of the slide is not suitable for expansion, you cannot expand the slide.

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 183

Creating summary slides

It is also possible to reverse the Expand operation and create summary slides. The Summary command is useful for creating an agenda for your presentation.

1) Select the slide that will be the first one to appear in the summary.

2) Go to Insert > Summary Slide on the main menu bar to create a new slide (Figure 153) at

the end of the presentation. All titles of the previous slides are written as bullet points in the body of the slide.

3) If necessary, move this slide to wherever you want it to appear in your presentation.

Figure 153: Summary slide

Deleting slides

You can delete a slide or slides from your presentation as follows::

1) In Normal view, go to Edit > Delete Slide, or right click in the Workspace and select Slide

> Delete Slide from the context menu, or press the Delete key. This deletes the slide displayed in the Workspace.

2) In Normal or Outline view, select a slide or slides in the Slides pane, then right-click and select Delete Slide from the context menu or press the Delete key.

3) In Slide Sorter view, select a slide or slides then right-click and select Delete Slide from the context menu.

Creating slides from an outline

When planning a presentation it may be useful to develop an outline using LibreOffice Writer. Once the outline is created, you can create one or more separate slides for each of the top level outline elements.

Using a Writer outline

The text document in Writer must contain headings formatted using heading paragraph styles.

1) Open the file in Writer that you want to use to create a presentation from.

2) Go to File > Send > Outline to Presentation on the Writer main menu bar to create a new presentation containing the headings as an outline.

3) A new presentation is created and opens in the Impress Outline view (Figure 154) and the

heading paragraph styles are converted into the outline styles used in Impress.

4) Some outline levels may have too many points to fit on one slide. You can expand this

slide, see “Expanding slides” on page 183, or duplicate the slide and manually change the

contents, see “Duplicating slides” on page 182.

184 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 154: Outline created from a LibreOffice Writer document

Using AutoAbstract

To create a presentation using AutoAbstract and send from Writer to Impress, the text must contain headings formatted with the heading paragraph styles. When using AutoAbstract to copy the headings and subsequent paragraphs to a new presentation, you can specify the number of outline levels as well as the number of paragraphs to be displayed.

1) Open the file in Writer that you want to use to create a presentation from.

2) Go to File > Send > AutoAbstract to Presentation on the Writer main menu bar to open

the Create AutoAbstract dialog (Figure 155).

3) Select the number of outline levels to be copied to the presentation in Included outline

levels. For example, if you choose three levels, all paragraphs formatted with heading levels 1 to 3 are included, along with the number of paragraphs specified in Paragraphs

per level.

4) A new presentation is created and opens in the Impress Outline view and the heading paragraph styles are converted into the outline styles used in Impress.

5) Some outline levels may have too many points to fit on one slide. You can expand this

slide, see “Expanding slides” on page 183, or duplicate the slide and manually change the

contents, see “Duplicating slides” on page 182.

6) When the presentation is created, some hierarchical structure of the outline may be lost. If necessary, use the Promote/Demote icons on the Text Formatting toolbar to move the outline points to the correct hierarchical levels.

Figure 155: Choosing outline levels for AutoAbstract

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 185

Copying and pasting an outline

Copy and paste an outline into an existing presentation or a new presentation as follows:

1) In Writer, open the file containing the outline you want to use in your presentation.

2) Highlight the outline and select Edit > Copy on the main menu bar, or right click on the outline and select Copy from the context menu.

3) Create a new presentation in Impress or create a new slide in an existing presentation that you want to use.

4) Select the Title, Content layout in the Tasks pane (see “Choosing a slide layout on page

188).

5) Paste the outline into the text area of the slide. Do not worry if the text does not fit the space on the slide.

6) If the slide contains too much text, either expand the slide, see “Expanding slides” on page

183, or duplicate the slide and manually change the contents, see “Duplicating slides” on page 182.

7) When the presentation is created, some hierarchical structure of the outline may be lost. If necessary, use the Promote/Demote icons on the Text Formatting toolbar to move the outline points to the correct hierarchical levels.

Tip

It may be useful to open the Style and Formatting window of the Presentation styles page to track the outline level of each item.

Modifying slides

Use slide masters to give your presentation a professional look and to avoid manually modifying the formatting of each individual slide. Multiple slide masters can be used in a single presentation to provide the same look for groups of slides and avoid modifying the formatting of each individual slide in a group of slides. See Chapter 2 Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates of this guide for more information about using slide masters.

186

Figure 156: Page Setup dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Formatting slides or page area

Note

Any changes to the page format (size, margins, orientation, and so on) apply to all slides in the presentation. You can only define one page style in Impress, whereas in

Writer or Calc you can define more than one page style. You can change the

background of individual slides, see “Changing slide background on page 188.

The Page Setup dialog (Figure 156) is used to set up the page and slide layout in Impress for the

Normal, Notes or Handouts views.

1) Make sure you are in Normal, Notes or Handout view.

2) Go to Format > Page on the main menu bar, or right-click on the slide and choose Slide >

Page Setup to open the Page Setup dialog (Figure 156).

3) Make your formatting changes using the options given below.

4) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

The options available on the Page Setup dialog are as follows:

Paper format – select from a list of predefined paper sizes, or define a custom paper format. The default value for the screen settings used for slides are for a screen presentation with 4:3 ratio. If your computer uses a wide-screen monitor, you can manually adjust the width and height to fit a wide-screen format.

Format – select a predefined paper size, or create a custom format by entering the dimensions for the paper in the Height and Width boxes.

Width – displays the width of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a width here.

Height – displays the height of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a height here.

Portrait – displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented vertically.

Landscape – displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented horizontally.

Text direction – select the text direction that you want to use in your document. The

"right-to-left (vertical)" text flow direction rotates all layout settings to the right by 90 degrees, except for the header and footer.

Paper tray – select the paper source for your printer. If you want, you can assign different paper trays to different page styles. For example, assign a different tray to the

First Page style and load the tray with your company's letterhead paper.

Preview field – displays a preview of the current selection.

Margins – specify the amount of space to leave between the edges of the page and the document text.

Left – enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the document text. If you are using a mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the inner text margin and the inner edge of the page.

Right – enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the document text. If you are using a mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the outer text margin and the outer edge of the page.

Top – enter the amount of space to leave between the upper edge of the page and the document text.

Bottom – enter the amount of space to leave between the lower edge of the page and the document text.

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 187

Layout settings

Format – select the page numbering format that you want to use for the current page style.

Fit object to page format – resizes the drawing objects so that they fit on the paper format that you select. The arrangement of the drawing objects is preserved.

Selecting slide masters

You can apply a master page to all the slides in a presentation or only selected slides in a presentation. This allows you to use more than one master page in a presentation. For more information on master pages, see Chapter 2 Slide Masters, Styles and Templates in this guide.

Please note that master pages are also called master slides or slide masters.

1) In the Task Pane, select the Master Pages tab to show the available master pages.

2) To apply a master page to all the slides in the presentation, right click on your selected master page and select Apply to All Slides from the context menu.

3) To apply a master page to one slide or several slides, select the slide or slides you want to apply the master page to, then right click on the master page and select Apply to Selected

Slides from the context menu.

Changing slide background

Tip

For easy maintenance it is recommended that slide masters are used to modify the slide backgrounds by creating any additional slide masters as required.

Note

Applying a background to individual slides is no different from filling the area of a shape. See Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic Objects in this guide for more information.

To change the background for all slides or a single slide:

1) Switch to Normal view by clicking the Normal tab in the Workspace pane or go to View >

Normal on the main menu bar.

2) Select a slide in your presentation.

3) Go to Format > Page on the main menu bar, or right-click on the slide and select Slide >

Page Setup to open the Page Setup dialog (Figure 156).

4) Click on the Background tab and follow the instructions in Chapter 6 Formatting Graphic

Objects in this guide to change the background.

5) Click OK to save the changes.

6) A pop-up message asks if you want to change the background on all slides. To apply the new background only to the selected slide or slides, click No. To apply the new background to all slides used in the presentation, click Yes.

Choosing a slide layout

After creating a new slide, you can then decide on what layout is most suitable for the slide contents and your presentation. Impress offers various types of predefined layouts that can be

applied to a slide (Figure 157).

If the layouts available in Impress do not fit your presentation style, elements can be rearranged on an individual slide and duplicated as often as required by copying to another presentation or saving it as a template.

188 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 157: Available slide layouts

All the techniques in Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text in this guide for working with text boxes can be applied to the title and auto layout text elements of a slide. The placeholder for images can be moved and resized, see Chapter 4 Adding and Formatting Pictures in this guide. Chapter 7

Including Spreadsheets, Charts, and Other Objects in this guide describes how to include and modify spreadsheets, charts, and other objects.

1) In the Tasks pane, select Layouts to display the various slide layouts available. If the Tasks pane is not visible, select View > Task Pane on the main menu.

2) Hover the cursor over a layout thumbnail to get a summary of the type of layout.

3) If this is the layout you require, click on the selected layout to apply it to the slide.

Note

If the layout is changed to slide that already contains text and objects, Impress will not delete these, but reposition them according to the selected layout. This may result in some elements overlapping or being out of position.

Comments

Adding comments

When creating a presentation in a collaborative environment, it is often useful to add comments to the presentation for the benefit of the other people working on the presentation.

1) Switch to Normal view and select the slide where you want the comment to appear.

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 189

Figure 158: Adding comments

2) Select Insert > Comment on the main menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+Alt+C

to display a comment box (Figure 158) in the top left corner of the slide. The size of the

comments box is fixed and scroll bars appear when needed.

3) Once you are finished typing your comment, close the comment box by clicking anywhere outside the comment box.

4) Each comment is color coded and marked with the initials of the author as well as a sequential number. This comment indicator is normally shown in the top left corner of the slide in Normal view. Clicking on a comment indicator displays the full text of the comment.

5) To move the comment indicator, click and drag it to a new position on the slide.

Editing, replying and deleting comments

Editing

You can only edit comments that you created and the editing options for comments are limited.

1) Open the comment by clicking on the comment indicator.

2) To change or add more text, simply click in the text and the cursor changes to the text tool.

3) To format the text, right click on the open comment and select the appropriate option from the context menu. Text can also be copied from another source and pasted into a comment.

4) Once you are finished editing your comment, close the comment box by clicking anywhere outside the comment box.

Replying

You can only reply to comments created by another person.

1) Open the comment by clicking on the comment indicator.

2) Click on the small triangle in the bottom right corner of the comment, or right click on the comment and select Reply from the context menu. This option is only available if more than one person has made comments.

3) Once you are finished replying to a comment, close the comment box by clicking anywhere outside the comment box.

190 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Deleting

You can delete the current comment that is open, delete all comments from the author of the selected comment, or delete all comments in the presentation.

1) Right click on a comment indicator and select the appropriate option from the context menu.

2) Alternatively, open a comment and click on the small triangle in the bottom right corner of the comment, or right click on the comment and select the appropriate option from the context menu.

Presentation notes

Notes provide a convenient way to create reminders or add extra information to slides in a presentation. Notes are not displayed during a slide show. However, using dual displays, you can display any notes on the second display as a presentation cue. You can also print the notes and use them as handouts.

Note

If you regularly give presentations in public using dual displays, you may want to consider using the Presenter Console, an extension that allows you to display on your screen the slide notes, the next slide, and other useful information while only the slide is shown through a projector or larger display. The Presenter Console is normally installed as part of LibreOffice and only becomes available when you are using a projector or dual displays. See Chapter 9 Slide Shows in this guide for more information on the Presenter Console.

Adding notes

1) Select the slide to which you want to add notes.

2) Click on the Notes tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Notes Page on the

main menu bar to open the Notes view (Figure 159).

3) Click in the text box showing Click to add notes and type or paste text or graphics as required.

4) To add notes to another slide, repeat steps 1 to 3.

5) When you have finished entering notes, return to Normal view.

Figure 159: Notes Page view

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 191

Formatting notes

It is recommended to use the Notes Master and the Notes Presentation style to format the appearance of notes, rather than formatting notes individually for each slide. All the formatting guidelines given in this section can be applied to either the Notes Master or to the Notes

Presentation style.

Figure 160: Notes Master layout

Formatting Notes page

1) Click on the Notes tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Notes Page on the

main menu bar to open the Notes view (Figure 159).

2) Go to View > Master > Notes Master on the main menu bar to open the Notes Master

layout (Figure 160).

3) Select Format > Page from the menu bar, or right-click and choose Page Setup to open

the Page Setup dialog (Figure 161).

4) Set the desired options for the page. See “Formatting slides or page area” on page 187 for

a description of the options available in the Page Setup dialog.

5) Click OK save your changes and to close the dialog.

192 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 161: Page Setup dialog for Notes and Handouts

Setting automatic layout options

In Notes, Impress can automatically enter information into four areas on the notes page:

Header area

Date and Time area

Footer area

Slide or page number area

Figure 162: Header and Footer dialog for Notes and Handouts

To setup these fields for automatic layout, proceed as follows:

1) Click on the Notes tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Notes Page on the

main menu bar to open the Notes view (Figure 159).

2) Go to View > Master > Notes Master on the main menu bar to open the Notes Master

layout (Figure 160).

3) Go to Insert > Page Number or Insert > Date and Time on the main menu bar to open the

Header and Footer dialog (Figure 162).

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 193

4) Click on the Notes and Handouts tab.

5) If required, check the Header option and the text to be included in the header in the text box.

6) If required, check the Date and Time option and select whether the date is to be Fixed or

Variable. If the date and time is fixed, enter the date and time that should be displayed in the text box. If the date and time is variable, select the date format and language to be used for the date and time.

7) If required, check the Footer option and the text to be included in the footer in the text box.

8) If required, check the Page number so that the page number appears on each page. To

format the type of numbering, refer to “Formatting Notes page” on page 192 or “Formatting slides or page area” on page 187 for more information.

9) Click Apply to All to save your changes and close the dialog.

Text formatting

When text is inserted in the Notes text box, it is automatically formatted using the predefined Notes style that you can find in the Presentation styles. The best way to format the notes text is to modify this style to suit your needs. Refer to Chapter 2 Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates of this guide for more information.

If manual formatting is required, for example to highlight a particular section of the notes, refer to

Chapter 3 Adding and Formatting Text of this guide for more information.

Note

You can move and resize the text box and slide image on the Notes page. Also, you can add more text boxes to the Notes page. Refer to the other chapters in this guide for more information.

194

Figure 163: Print dialog – General page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Printing notes

1) Click on the Notes tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Notes Page on the

main menu bar to open the Notes view (Figure 159).

2) Go to File > Print on the main menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+P to open the

Print dialog (Figure 163).

3) Click on the General tab, select Notes from the Print > Document drop down list.

4) Make any other necessary changes to the printing options, for example number of copies and print range.

5) Click OK to print and close the Print dialog.

For more information on printing slides, notes, and handouts, see Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing,

Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows in this guide.

Exporting notes as PDF

1) Click on the Notes tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Notes Page on the

main menu bar to open the Notes view (Figure 159).

2) Go to File > Export as PDF on the main menu bar to open the PDF Options dialog (Figure

164).

3) Click on the General tab.

4) In the General section, check the Export notes pages option.

5) Make any other necessary changes to the PDF export options and click OK to close the

PDF options dialog.

6) In the Export dialog that opens, enter a filename and select a folder in which to save the file.

7) Click Export to export and save the file, and close the Export dialog.

Figure 164: PDF Options dialog – General page

Note

If your presentation has 10 slides, the PDF will contain 20 pages consisting of 10 pages of individual slides followed by 10 pages with notes formatted for paper. If you want only the Notes pages, you will need to use another program to remove the unwanted pages of slides from the PDF file.

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 195

Presentation handouts

A handout is a special view of the presentation suitable for printing and distribution to the audience.

Each handout page can contain from one to nine thumbnails of the slides used in the presentation so that the audience can follow what is being presented as well as use the handouts for reference.

This section explains how to customize the handout page.

Note that the Handout view consists of only one page regardless of the number of slides in the presentation or the number of pages of slides that will be printed.

Figure 165: Handout page with nine slide thumbnails

196

Figure 166: Layouts for handouts

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Changing layout

When creating handouts, first decide how many slide thumbnails you want printed on each handout page.

1) Click on the Handout tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Handout Page on

the main menu bar to open the Handout page (Figure 165).

2) Click on Layouts in the Tasks pane to open the layouts available for handouts. If the Task

pane is not visible, select View > Task Pane on the main menu bar (Figure 166).

3) Select the preferred number of thumbnails and the Workspace changes to reflect the selection.

Formatting handouts

You can format several aspects of the handout, from the page style to the elements that appear on the page. You cannot format individual handout pages and any changes apply to all handouts in the presentation file.

Handout page formatting

1) Click on the Handout tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Handout Page on

the main menu bar to open the Handout page (Figure 165).

2) Select Format > Page from the main menu, or right-click on the handout and select Slide >

Page Setup from the pop-up menu to open the Page Setup dialog (Figure 161).

3) Set the paper size, orientation (portrait or landscape), margins, and other print options.

4) Click OK to close the Print dialog and print the handouts.

Setting automatic layout options

In Handouts, Impress can automatically enter information into four areas on the handout page.

Refer to “Setting automatic layout options” on page 193 for more information on setting the

automatic layout options for handouts.

Header area

Date and Time area

Footer area

Slide or page number area

Note

The information in these areas does not show in Handout view, but does appear correctly on the printed handouts.

Moving thumbnails and adding graphics

You can move (but not resize) the slide thumbnails and add lines, boxes, and other graphic elements to the handouts. See Chapter 5 Managing Graphic Objects in this guide for more information on using the graphics tools.

Tip

After designing a handout, you may wish to save it in a template so you can reuse it whenever you want. See Chapter 2 Slide Masters, Styles, and Templates in this guide for information on saving templates and starting a new presentation from a template.

Chapter 8 Adding and Formatting Slides, Notes, and Handouts 197

Note

If you click on one of the other handout layouts and then return to the one you have reformatted, the slide thumbnails return to their original positions, although any lines or other graphics you have added remain where you put them. You will need to move the thumbnails back to where you want them.

Printing handouts

1) Click on the Handout tab at the top of the Workspace or go to View > Handout Page on

the main menu bar to open the Handout page (Figure 165).

2) Go to File > Print on the main menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+P to open the

Print dialog (Figure 163).

3) Click on the General tab, select Handouts from the Print > Document drop down list.

4) Make any other necessary changes to the printing options, for example number of copies and print range.

5) Click OK to print and close the Print dialog.

For more information on printing slides, notes, and handouts, see Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing,

Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows in this guide.

Exporting handouts as PDF

At present there is no way to export handouts to PDF. If you try, then the PDF file only contains slides with one slide per page. However, you can print to a PostScript file, if you have a postscript printer driver installed, and then use another program (for example Ghostscript or Adobe Acrobat) to create a PDF file from a PostScript file.

198 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Chapter

9

Slide Shows

Transitions, animations, and more

Creating a slide show

LibreOffice Impress gives you the tools to organize and display a slide show, including:

Which slides to show and in what sequence

Whether to run the show automatically or manually

Transitions between slides

Animations on individual slides

Interactions: what happens when you click a button or link

A presenter console

Most tasks associated with putting together a slide show are best done in Slide Sorter view. Go to

View > Slide Sorter on the main menu bar or click the Slide Sorter tab at the top of the

Workspace pane. All of your slides appear in the workspace and you may have to scroll to see them all.

Basic settings

Basic settings for a slide show include which slide to start from, the way you advance the slides, the type of presentation, and pointer options.

1) Go to View > Slide Sorter on the main menu bar, or click on the Slide Sorter tab in the

Workspace.

2) Go Slide Show > Slide Show Settings on the main menu bar to open the Slide Show

dialog (Figure 167).

3) Select the options you want to use for your slide show. See “Slide Show options” on page

201 for more information on options.

4) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

200

Figure 167: Slide Show dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Slide Show options

In the Range section, select which slides to include in the slide show:

All slides – includes all slides except for those slides marked Hidden (see “Hiding slides” on page 202). Slides are shown in the sequence they occur in the file. To change the

sequence, either rearrange the slides in the slide sorter or choose a custom slide show

(see below).

From – starts the show at a slide other than the first slide. For example, you might have several slides at the beginning that describe you and your company, but when you present this show to your work colleagues, you may want to skip that introduction.

Custom Slide Show – shows the slides in a different sequence that you have previously set up. This setting is not available until you have set up a custom slide show (see

“Showing slides in a different order” on page 202). You can set up as many different custom

shows as you wish from one set of slides and they will appear in the drop-down list under this option.

In the Type section, select how the slides will be displayed:

Default – shows the slides full screen without the LibreOffice program controls visible and exits the show after the last slide.

Window – runs the slide show in the Impress window and exits the show after the last slide.

Auto – restarts the slide show after the last slide. A pause slide is displayed between the last slide and the start slide. Press the Esc key to stop the show. In the box, specify the length of time before the show restarts. If you enter zero, the show restarts immediately without showing a pause slide. The Show Logo option shows the LibreOffice logo on the pause slide.

In the Options section:

Change slides manually – prevents slides from changing automatically even if an automatic transition has been set up.

Mouse pointer visible – shows the mouse pointer during a slide show. If you do not have a laser pointer or other device to highlight items of interest during the show, this can be useful.

Mouse pointer as pen – enables you to write or draw on slides during the presentation.

Anything you write with the pen is not saved when you exit the slide show. The color of the pen cannot be changed.

Navigator visible – displays the Navigator during the slide show. For more information on the Navigator, see Chapter 1 Introducing Impress in this guide.

Animations allowed – displays all frames of animated GIF files during the slide show. If this option is not selected, only the first frame of an animated GIF file is displayed. This has

nothing to do with the slide animations described in “Using animation effects” on page 207.

Change slides by clicking on background – advances to the next slide when you click on the background of a slide. You can also press the spacebar on the keyboard to advance to the next slide.

Presentation always on top – prevents any other program window from appearing on top of the presentation.

In the Multiple displays section:

You can select which display to use for full screen slide show mode. Only available if the current computer desktop is displayed on more than one monitor.

If the current desktop is displayed on only one monitor, or if the multiple-display feature is not supported on the current system, you cannot select another display.

By default the primary display is used for slide show mode.

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 201

Note

The multiple displays setting is not an option saved with the presentation file, but is instead saved as a local setting in the user configuration. This means that if you open the presentation on a different computer the local settings for that computer are applied.

Hiding slides

You may not want to show all of the slides in a particular slide show. You can either hide some of the slides or set up a custom slide show; whichever method suits your requirements. For example, you may have draft slides that you do not want to show until they are finished, or you may have some slides that contain information for yourself, but not your audience.

To hide a slide:

1) In the Slides pane, or in Slide Sorter view, select the slides that you want to hide.

2) Click the Hide Slide icon

on the Slide View toolbar (Figure 168), or right-click and

select Hide Slide from the context menu, or go to Slide Show > Hide Slide on the main

menu bar. The slide is now displayed grayed out to indicate that it is hidden (Figure 169).

The slide is not deleted and remains in the file. The Hide Slide icon is only active when a slide is selected in your presentation.

Figure 168: Slide View toolbar

Figure 169: Slide 2 is hidden

To show a hidden slide:

1) In the Slides pane, or in Slide Sorter view, select the hidden slides that you want to show.

2) Click the Show Slide icon

on the Slide View toolbar (Figure 168), or right-click and

select Show Slide from the context menu, or go to Slide Show > Show Slide on the main menu bar. The Slide Show icon is only active when the hidden slides are selected in your presentation.

Showing slides in a different order

To show the slides in a different order, you can either rearrange them in the slide sorter, or set up a custom slide show. You can define as many custom slide shows as you require from one set of slides.

In a custom slide show, you can select which slides to include as well as the order in which they are shown. Any hidden slides will not appear in a custom show.

202 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Custom slide show

To set up a new custom slide show:

1) Go to Slide Show > Custom Slide Show on the main menu bar to open the Custom Slide

Shows dialog (Figure 170).

2) Click on New and the Define Custom Slide Show dialog opens (Figure 171).

3) Type a name for the new custom show in the Name text box.

4) In the Existing slides list, select the slides to include in the show. Click the >> button to

include the slides in the Selected slides list. In Figure 171, the first three slides have been

selected.

5) You can select and include several slides at the same time. Hold down the Shift key and click the first and last slide in a group to select that group, or hold down the Ctrl key and click on individual slides to select them.

6) When you have finished arranging the order of the slides, click OK to save this custom show and return to the Custom Slide Shows dialog.

Figure 170: Custom Slide Shows dialog

Figure 171: Define Custom Show dialog

7) To activate a custom show, select it in the list in the Custom Slide Shows dialog box and then select the Use Custom Slide Show option.

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 203

Note

Tip

If you include several slides at the same time, they are added to the Selected slides list in the order they appear in your presentation regardless of the order in which you selected them. To put the selected slides in a different order, either select and include each slide individually or select a slide and drag it up or down in the selected slide list. You can also use the Slide Sorter view to rearrange the order of slides before making your selection.

Slides are added to the Selected slides list after the slide that is currently highlighted in the list. By default, the last slide added is highlighted unless you have selected a

different one. For example, in Figure 171, to add the slide Final Slide Example after

the First Slide Example and before Slide2, make sure that First Slide Example is highlighted before moving Final Slide Example into Selected slides list.

Editing, deleting, or copying a custom slide show

1) To edit a custom slide show (add, remove, or change the order of slides, or change the

name of the show), select it in the Custom Slide Shows dialog (Figure 170) and click Edit.

2) To delete a custom slide show, select it in the Custom Slide Shows dialog and click Delete.

Deletion is immediate and no confirmation message appears.

3) To create a copy of a slide show, select it in the Custom Slide Shows dialog and click

Copy. You can now edit the copy by renaming and adding, removing, or changing the order of slides in it.

4) You can preview your custom slide show from the Custom Slide Shows dialog if the Use

Custom Slide Show option is selected. Select the slide show from the list and click on

Start.

5) When you have finished working with custom slide shows, click Close to save all changes and close the Custom Slide Shows dialog.

Using slide transitions

Slide transitions are the effects that take place between slides when slides change in a presentation. Transitions can add a professional look to a slide show, smoothing the change over between slides.

Adding transitions

1) In the Tasks pane, select Slide Transition (Figure 172).

2) In the Slides pane or Slide Sorter view, select the slides to which you want to apply the transition. If you want the transition to apply to all slides, do not select any slides.

3) In the Apply to selected slides list, select a transition.

4) Modify the selected transition by changing the speed or adding a sound, in the Modify

transition section. If you decide to play a sound during transitions, select a sound from the

Sound list.

5) If a sound is selected, the Loop until next sound option becomes active. Select this option to play the sound repeatedly until another sound starts. If there are no subsequent sounds in your slide show, the selected sound will play continuously for the remainder of the show.

204 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 172: Slide transitions

6) Select how to advance to the next slide: manually (On mouse click) or automatically

(Automatically after). If you select an automatic advance, you can specify how long the slide remains visible before it automatically advances to the next slide.

7) If you want the transition to apply to all slides, click Apply to All Slides.

8) To start the slide show from the current slide so you can check your transitions, click Slide

Show.

9) If the Automatic preview checkbox is marked, the effect of a selected transition is immediately displayed in the work area. You can replay the effect at any time by clicking

Play.

Tip

You can apply a single type of transition to all slides in the presentation or apply a different transition to any single slide in the slide show. While using many different transitions may be fun to do, it may not give your slide show a professional appearance.

Tip

If you want most of the slides in your slide show to have the same transition and only use a few different transitions, you may find it easier to apply one transition to all slides and then change only the ones you want to be different.

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 205

Removing transitions

1) Select the slides from where you want to remove the transitions.

2) Select No Transition in the Slide Transition list on the Tasks pane.

Setting timing of automatic slide changes

You can set up a slide show to run automatically, either unattended or while you speak.

Default timing

To set the default time for slides to be displayed before changing to the next slide:

1) In the Tasks pane, select Slide Transition (Figure 172).

2) Leave the transition effect set to No Transition.

3) Select Automatically after in the Advance slide section.

4) Set a time and click Apply to All Slides.

Variable timing

To vary the timing for some of the slides in your slide show:

1) Select Slide Show > Rehearse Timings from the main menu, or click the Rehearse

Timings icon on the Slide Show toolbar. The slide show begins in full-screen mode and a timer appears in the lower left corner of the display.

2) When you want to advance to the next slide, click the timer. To keep the default setting for this slide, click the slide and not the timer.

3) Continue until you have set the timing for all slides in your presentation. Impress records the display time for each slide. When you next look at the time set under Automatically

after, you will see that the times have changed to match what you set when rehearsing.

4) To exit from the rehearsal, press the Esc key or right-click on the slide and select End

Show from the context menu.

Auto repeat

If you want the whole presentation to auto-repeat:

1) Open the Slide Show dialog (Figure 167) by going to Slide Show > Slide Show Settings

on the main menu bar.

2) Click Auto and set the timing for the pause between slide shows.

3) Select Show logo if you want the LibreOffice logo to show during the pause between slide shows.

4) Click OK to save the settings and close the dialog.

Playing sounds

You can use the Slide Transition pane to select a sound or song that is played throughout your presentation.

1) Select the slide where you want the sound to start.

1) In the Tasks pane, select Slide Transition (Figure 172).

2) In the Modify transition section, select Other sound from the Sound drop-down list.

3) Navigate to where the sound file is located in the Open dialog that opens.

4) Select the sound file you want to use and click Play to check if the sound file is suitable.

5) If the sound file is suitable, click Open.

6) Select Loop until next sound if you want the sound to restart once it is finished.

206 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Note

Do not click the Apply to all button; otherwise your selected sound will restart at every slide.

Note

The sound file is linked to a presentation rather than embedded. Therefore if you plan to display the presentation on a different computer, remember that you also have to make the sound file available on the computer where the presentation will be played, and re-establish the link to the sound file before starting the slide show.

Using animation effects

Slide animations are similar to transitions, but they are applied to individual elements in a single slide: title, chart, shape, or individual bullet point. Animations can make a presentation more lively and memorable. Just as with transitions, heavy use of animations can be fun, but distracting and even annoying for an audience expecting a professional presentation.

Animation effects are applied from Normal view so that you can select individual objects on a single slide.

Note

At present it is not possible to apply animation effects to the slide master elements.

This means that if you want to display the items in a text box one by one, and use the same animation on more than one slide, you need to apply the effects to each slide, or alternatively copy the text box from one slide to another.

Applying animation effects

In Normal view, display the desired slide and then select the text or object you want to animate. An object such as a graphic or an entire text box will have selection handles around it when selected.

If you choose only a portion of the text in a text box, you may not see any selection handles.

1) Go to View > Normal on the main menu bar, or click on the Normal tab in the Workspace.

2) Select the slide and the object you want to apply the animation effect to.

3) In the Tasks pane, select Custom Animation (Figure 173) and then click Add to open the

Custom Animation dialog (Figure 174).

4) Select the animation effect types from one of the tabbed pages on the Custom Animation dialog. More than one type of animation effect can be applied to an object.

a) Use the Entrance page to be apply an animation effect when an object is placed on the screen.

b) Use the Emphasis page to apply an animation effect to an object, for example changing font color, or adding special effects such as blinking text.

c) Use the Exit page to apply an animation effect when an object leaves the screen.

d) If you want the object to move along a line or curve, select an animation effect from the

Motion Paths page. An example of this type of animation is provided in “Setting up a motion path” on page 212.

5) Select the duration of the animation effect from the Speed drop down list.

6) If required, select Automatic preview so you can check the animation effect on the object.

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 207

Figure 174: Custom Animation dialog

Figure 173: Custom animation

7) Click OK to apply the animation effect and close the dialog. Each animation effect applied appears in the list on the Custom Animation section of the Tasks pane.

8) Select an animation effect in the list and then select from the Start drop list how the animation effect starts.

a) On click − the animation does not start until you click the mouse.

b) With previous − the animation runs at the same time as the previous animation.

c) After previous − the animation runs as soon as the previous animation ends.

9) With the animation effect still selected in the list, select a direction on how the object appears on the slide from the Direction drop list. The options available in this drop down list may change depending on the type of animation effect being used.

10) If necessary and with the animation effect still selected in the list, change the speed of the animation effect using the Speed drop list.

11) If necessary, change the order of the animation list by selecting an animation effect and clicking on the Change order up or down arrow.

12) Click Play to check how the animation effect looks on the slide.

13) Click Slide Show to check how your presentation runs and looks.

Changing animation effects

1) On the Custom Animation section on the Tasks pane, select the animation effect.

2) Click Change, then follow “Applying animation effects” above.

208 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Removing animation effects

1) On the Custom Animation section on the Tasks pane, select the animation effect.

2) Click Remove.

Additional properties for animation effects

Many animation effects have properties or options that you can set or change. That actual properties or options that will be available will depend on which animation effect you have selected.

1) On the Custom Animation section on the Tasks pane, select an animation effect.

2) Click the button next to the Direction drop down list to open the Effect Options dialog.

3) Click on a tab to open the options for the type of effect options you want to change and use.

a) Effect – Specifies the settings and enhancements of the selected animation effect

(Figure 175).

b) Timing – specifies the timing for the selected animation effect (Figure 176).

c) Text Animation – specifies how the text is animated for the selected animation effect

(Figure 177).

4) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Effect page options

Specifies the settings and enhancements for the current effect (Figure 175).

Direction – specifies the direction for the effect.

Sound – select a sound from the Gallery or select one of the special entries.

No sound – no sound is played during animation of the effect.

Stop previous sound – the sound of the previous effect is stopped as soon as the current effect runs.

Other sound – displays a file open dialog to select a sound file.

Sound button – plays the selected sound file.

After animation – select a color to be shown after the animation ends, or select another after-effect from the list.

Dim with color – after the animation a dim color fills the shape.

Don't dim – no after-effect runs.

Figure 175: Effect Options dialog – Effect page

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 209

Hide after animation – hides the shape after the animation ends.

Hide on next animation – hides the shape on the next animation.

Dim color – select the dim color.

Text animation – select the animation mode for the text of the current shape:

All at once – animates the text all at once.

Word by word – animates the text word by word.

Letter by letter – animates the text letter by letter.

Delay between characters – specifies the percentage of delay between animations of words or letters.

Timing page options

Specifies the timing for the current effect (Figure 176).

Start – displays the start property of the selected animation effect.

On click – the animation stops at this effect until the next mouse click.

With previous – the animation runs immediately.

After previous – the animation runs as soon as the previous animation ends.

Delay – specifies an additional delay of n seconds until the effect starts.

Speed – specifies the duration of the effect.

Repeat – specifies whether and how to repeat the current effect. Enter the number of repeats, or select from the list:

(none) – the effect is not repeated.

Until next click – the animation is repeated until the next mouse click.

Until end of slide – the animation repeats as long as the slide is displayed.

Rewind when done playing – specifies whether to let the animated shape return to its starting state after the animation ends.

Animate as part of click sequence – specifies whether to let the animation start in the normal click sequence.

Start effect on click of – specifies whether to let the animation start when a specified shape is clicked. Select the shape by its name from the list box.

210

Figure 176: Effect Options dialog – Timing page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 177: Effect Options dialog – Text Animation page

Text animation page options

Specifies the text animation settings for the current effect (Figure 177).

Group text – specifies how multiple paragraphs are animated:

As one object – all paragraphs are animated as one object.

All paragraphs at once – all paragraphs are animated at once, but can have different effects.

By 1st level paragraphs – the first level paragraphs, including sub-level paragraphs, are animated one after another.

Automatically after – if "Group text – By 1st level paragraphs" is selected, the paragraphs are animated one after the other. Enter an additional delay in seconds to animate subsequent paragraphs.

Animate attached shape – deselect this box to animate only the text, not the shape.

In reverse order – animates the paragraphs in reverse order.

Examples of animation effects

Using multiple animation effects

To illustrate how you can set up multiple effects, the following example shows you how to animate list items that fly in one at a time from the bottom of the slide and, as each new item appears, the previous items change to a different color.

1) Go to View > Normal on the main menu bar, or click on the Normal tab in the Workspace.

2) Select a slide with a list of at least three items you want to apply the animation effect to.

3) In the Tasks pane, select Custom Animation (Figure 173).

4) Select all the items and click Add to open the Custom Animation dialog (Figure 174).

5) Click the Entrance tab to open the Entrance page of the Custom Animation dialog.

6) Select the Fly In effect and change the speed to Medium.

Figure 178: Example of animated points

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 211

7) Click OK and the Fly In animation effect is indicated next the list of items in the Custom

Animation page (Figure 178).

8) Select the first three items on the slide and not in the animations list, then select From

bottom from the Direction drop down list.

9) With the first three items still selected, click Add in the Custom Animation pane o open the

Custom Animation dialog (Figure 174).

10) Click the Emphasis tab to open the Emphasis page of the Custom Animation dialog.

11) Select Change Font Color and click OK to save this animated effect. The three new animation effects are now listed at the bottom of the animations list and the indicator has changed to show an emphasis effect has been added to these items.

12) Select the three items at the bottom of the list with the Change Font Color animated effect.

13) Use the Change order up-and down arrows to move each of these three items up the list so that they are each under the other item with the same name that has the Fly In animated effect.

14) Select the three items that the Change Font Color animation effect and then select On

click for the Start drop down list.

15) Select items two and three in the list that have the Fly In animation effect and then select

With previous from the Start drop down list.

16) To test the animation effects, click Slide Show and then click the mouse button to start the animation.

Setting up a motion path

A motion path effect moves an object along a path consisting of a combination of straight and curved lines. Several pre-packaged motion paths are provided in LibreOffice, but it is not difficult to create your own custom path as follows. You can also combine a motion path with other animation effects such as spinning or changing of size or colors to create dramatic effects.

1) Select the object you want to animate.

2) In the Tasks pane, select Custom Animation (Figure 173).

3) Click Add to open the Custom Animation dialog (Figure 174).

4) Click the Motion Paths tab to open the Motion Paths page of the Custom Animation dialog.

5) Select a pre-packaged motion path animation that is similar to the effect you want to obtain.

Alternatively use the Polygon or Curve animation effect to create a new motion path.

6) Select the object to show the animation path, which will be displayed as a thin gray line with a triangle showing the starting point.

7) Click on the animation path so that selection handles are displayed around it. When the selection handles are shown, you can move or resize the path the same way you would perform these operations on an object.

Note

When moving a path, remember to also move the object on that path; otherwise the animation will start with a jump. Currently it is not possible to rotate a path.

212

8) While the path is selected. select the Points icon on the Drawing toolbar or press the

F8 key to display the Edit Points toolbar (Figure 179). If is not displayed, go to View >

Toolbars > Edit Points on the main menu bar. The number of icons available in the Edit

Points toolbar will depend on the type of motion path and object selected.

9) Once a point is selected, you can delete the point, move the point, or add another point and so on. For a detailed explanation on how to manipulate the points on a curve, see the Draw

Guide.

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 179: Edit Points toolbar and icons

10) When you are satisfied with the shape of the curve and its speed, click anywhere on the screen to deselect the object and continue normal editing.

11) To test the motion path, click Slide Show and then click the mouse button to start the animation.

Using interactions

Interactions are things that happen when you click on an object in a slide. They are typically used with buttons or images, but text objects can also have interactions.

To apply an interaction to an object (or change an interaction applied to an object):

1) Select the object, then right-click on the object and select Interaction from the context menu, or go to Slide Show > Interaction on the main menu bar to open the Interaction

dialog (Figure 180).

2) Select an interaction from the Action at mouse click drop-down list. With some interactions, the Interaction dialog changes to offer more options.

3) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Figure 180: Interaction dialog

Tip

A sound interaction can be also applied using the Effect Options dialog See

“Additional properties for animation effects” on page 209 for more information.

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 213

Slide shows

Running a slide show

To run a slide show:

1) Open your presentation using LibreOffice Impress.

2) Press the F5 key, or go to Slide Show > Slide Show on the main menu bar, or click the

Slide Show icon on the Presentation toolbar or the Slide Sorter toolbar.

3) If the slide transition is set to Automatically after x seconds, let the slide show run by itself.

4) If the slide transition is set to On mouse click, press the down arrow key, the right arrow key, or the Page Down key on the keyboard, click the left mouse button, or press the

Spacebar.

5) To navigate backwards through the slide show one slide at a time, press the up arrow key, the left arrow key, or the Page Up key.

6) For more complex navigation during the slide show, use the right-click navigation (see

“Right-click navigation and options” below).

7) When you advance past the last slide, the message Click to exit presentation... appears.

Click the left mouse button or press any key to exit the presentation.

8) To exit the slide show and return to the Impress workspace at any time, including at the end of the slide show, press the Esc key.

Note

Any custom animations on a slide are run in the specified order when performing one of the above actions while running the slide show.

Right-click navigation and options

If your presentation consists of more than one slide, right-clicking anywhere on the screen brings up a context menu. The options are as follows:

Next – moves to the next slide in the defined sequence.

Previous – moves to the previous slide in the defined sequence.

Go to Slide – displays a submenu allowing to quickly select and navigate to any slide in the presentation. Options on the submenu include First slide, Last Slide, or any slide in the presentation and illustrates why giving the slides meaningful names, rather than leaving them at the default Slide 1, Slide 2, and so on, can be very helpful.

Mouse pointer as Pen – allows you to use the cursor as a pen and draw on a slide to emphasize or explain a point.

Pen Width – adjusts the width of any lines drawn when using the cursor as a pen.

Change pen Color – allows you to change the color of any line when using the cursor as a pen.

Erase all ink on Slide – deletes all lines drawn after you have finished using the cursor as a pen.

Screen – displays a submenu with two options. Each option blanks the screen, showing it as either all black or all white. This can be useful if you want to pause the show for awhile, perhaps during a break or to demonstrate something on another computer.

End Show – ends the presentation and returns you to the Impress workspace. This is the same effect as pressing the Esc key.

214 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Using the Presenter Console

Most installations of LibreOffice Impress come with the Presenter Console extension built in. If it is not included, you can also get the extension and install it as described in Chapter 11, Setting up

and Customizing Impress.

The Presenter Console provides extra control over slide shows when using dual displays for a slide show, such as a laptop for yourself and large display or projector for your audience.

Figure 181: Presenter Console

The view you see on your computer display includes the current slide that can be seen by the audience, the next slide in your presentation, any slide notes, and a presentation timer.

Note

The Presenter Console works only on operating systems that support two displays, and only when two displays are connected (one may be the laptop display).

The Presenter Console provides the following easily changeable views:

First view, which is the default view, displays the current slide, including the effects, and the upcoming slide. Click on the Previous and Next arrows to navigate through your presentation.

Second view shows the notes for the speaker in large, scalable type, plus the current and upcoming slides. Click on the Notes icon to switch to this view. Click on the Notes icon again to return to the first view.

Third view is a slide sorter view with the slide thumbnails where you can select a thumbnail to jump to a slide out of sequence. Click on the Slides icon to switch to this view. Click on the Slides icon again to return to the first view.

Click on the Exchange icon to switch the Presenter Console between displays.

Click on the Help icon to display a list of the controls that are available in the Presenter

Console. Click on the Help icon again to return to the previous view.

Chapter 9 Slide Shows 215

Chapter

10

Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows

Introduction

This chapter provides information about printing, exporting, and e-mailing documents from

LibreOffice Impress.

Quick printing

Click the Print File Directly icon on the Standard toolbar to send the entire document to the default printer defined for your computer.

Note

You can change the action of the Print File Directly icon to send the document to a printer defined for the document instead of the default printer for the computer.

Go to Tools > Options > Load/Save > General and select the Load printer

settings with the document option.

Controlling printing

Impress provides many options for printing a presentation; for example multiple slides on one page, single slide per page, slides with notes, as an outline, with date and time, with page name, and so on.

For more control over printing a presentation, go to File > Print on the menu bar, or the keyboard

shortcut Ctrl+P to open the Print dialog (Figure 182). The Print dialog has four tabbed pages where

you can choose a range of options, as described in the following sections.

218

Note

Figure 182. Print dialog – General page

The options selected in the Print dialog apply to this printing of this document only. To specify default printing settings, go to Tools > Options > LibreOffice > Print and

Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress – Print. See “Selecting default print options” on page 221 for more information.

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

General printing

On the General page of the Print dialog (Figure 182):

1) Select a printer from the list of printers available.

2) Select the slides to print, the number of copies to print, whether to collate multiple copies and to reverse printing order using the Range and copies section.

3) Select whether to print slides, notes, handouts, or an outline of the presentation, slides per page and printing order using the Print section.

4) Click Properties to display a Properties dialog. Actual printer properties available will depend on the printer being used and type of computer operating system being used.

d) On the Paper page, select paper size to use, portrait or landscape orientation, double

sided printing (if available) and the paper tray to use. An example is shown in Figure 183.

e) On the Device page, select output resolution, color model, media type, amount of

extension, printer language type, color and color depth. An example is shown in Figure 184.

5) Click OK to print your presentation and close the dialog.

Figure 183: Example of a Properties dialog – Paper page

Figure 184: Example of a Properties dialog – Device page

Example of selecting slides to print

To print an individual slide or several slides:

1) Open the Print dialog and select the General page. Then, do one of the following:

To print a single slide or a selection of slides, select the Slides option in the Ranges

and copies section and type the slide numbers in the text box. Separate each slide number by a comma, for example 1,3,7,11.

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 219

To print a range of slides, select the Slides option in the Ranges and copies section and type the slide numbers in the text box as a range, for example 1-4.

To print a selection of slides, select the slides in the Slides pane or Slide Sorter view and then select Selection in the Range and copies section.

2) Click OK to print your slides and close the dialog.

Example of printing handouts

Handouts of slides can be printed using one to nine slides per page. The slides can be printed horizontally (landscape orientation) or vertically (portrait orientation) on the page. To print handouts:

1) Open the Print dialog and select the General page.

2) In the Print section of the Print dialog, select Handouts from the Document drop-down list.

3) Select how many slides to print per page and the order in which they are printed.

4) Click OK to print your slides and close the dialog.

LibreOffice Impress

On the LibreOffice Impress page of the print dialog (Figure 185), you can select how your

presentation is printed using the Contents, Color and Size sections.

Figure 185. Print dialog – LibreOffice Impress page

220

Figure 186. Print dialog – Page Layout page

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Page layout

On the Page Layout page of the print dialog (Figure 186), you can select how your presentation is

printed using the Layout and Page sides sections.

Example of printing multiple pages on a single sheet of paper

You can print multiple pages of a document on one sheet of paper. To do this:

1) Open the Print dialog and select the Page Layout page.

2) In Layout, select from the drop-down list the number of pages to print per sheet. The preview panel on the left shows how the printed document will look.

3) When printing more than two pages per sheet, select the Order in which they are printed across and down the paper.

4) Select whether to Draw a border around each page that is printed.

5) In the Page sides section, select whether to print all pages or only some pages.

6) Click OK to print the presentation and close the dialog.

Options

The Options page of the Print dialog (Figure 187) allows you to select other options for printing

your presentation.

Figure 187: Print dialog – Options page

Selecting default print options

Printing options selected in the Print dialog override any default settings any default settings for printing that have been set using Tools > Options > LibreOffice Impress > Print.

Other default printer settings are found in Tools > Options > LibreOffice > Print. Use these settings to specify quality settings for printing, and whether to have Impress warn you if the paper size or orientation of your document does not match the printer settings. See Chapter 11 Setting

Up and Customizing Impress for more information.

Brochure printing

You can print a presentation with two slides on each side of a sheet of paper, arranged so that when the printed pages are folded in half, the slides are in the correct order to form a booklet or brochure.

Single sided printing

To print a brochure on a printer that can only print single-sided pages:

1) Go to File > Print on the menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+P to open the Print

dialog (Figure 182 on page 218).

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 221

2) Make sure the Print dialog has the General page open.

3) Click Properties and check the printer is set to the same orientation (portrait or landscape) as specified in the page setup for your document. Usually the orientation does not matter, but it does for brochures. Click OK to return to the Print dialog.

4) Select which slides you want printed as a brochure in the Range and copies section. You have to select four or more slides for brochure printing.

5) Select the Page layout page in the Print dialog (Figure 186 on page 220).

6) Select the Brochure option in the Layout section.

7) In the Page sides section, select Back sides / left pages option from the Include dropdown list.

8) Click OK to close the Print dialog and print the first page side of selected slides.

9) Take the printed pages out of the printer, turn the pages over, and put them back into the printer in the correct orientation to print on the blank side. You may need to experiment a bit to find out what the correct arrangement is for your printer.

10) Repeat Steps 1 through 6 above.

11) In the Page sides section, select Front sides / right pages option from the Include dropdown list.

12) Click OK to close the print dialog and print the second page side of selected slides.

Duplex printing

To print a brochure on a printer that can print double-sided pages (duplex printing):

1) Go to File > Print on the menu bar, or use the keyboard shortcut Ctrl+P to open the Print

dialog (Figure 182 on page 218).

2) Make sure the Print dialog has the General page open.

3) Click Properties and check the printer is set to the same orientation (portrait or landscape) as specified in the page setup for your document. Usually the orientation does not matter, but it does for brochures. Click OK to return to the Print dialog.

4) Select which slides you want printed as a brochure in the Range and copies section. You have to select four or more slides for brochure printing.

5) Select the Page layout page in the Print dialog (Figure 186 on page 220).

6) Select the Brochure option in the Layout section.

7) In the Page sides section, select All pages option from the Include drop-down list.

8) Click OK to close the Print dialog and print your selected slides as a brochure.

PDF export

Impress can export presentations to PDF (Portable Document Format). This industry-standard file format for file viewing is ideal for sending the file to someone else to view using Adobe Reader or other PDF viewers.

Quick export

Click the Export Directly as PDF icon on the Standard toolbar to export the entire presentation using the default PDF settings. You are asked to enter the file name and location for the PDF file, but you cannot select a page range or print quality for the PDF file.

222 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Controlling PDF content and quality

For more control over the content and quality of the PDF produced:

1) Go to File > Export as PDF on the menu bar to open the PDF Options dialog (Figure 188).

This dialog has five pages and the options available are described below.

2) Make your selections and then click Export.

3) Enter the location and file name of the PDF to be created.

4) Click Save to export the file.

Figure 188: PDF Options dialog – General page

General options

On the General page (Figure 188), you can select which pages (slides) to include in the PDF, the

type of compression to use for images (this affects the quality of images in the PDF), and so on.

Range – sets the export options for the slides to be included in the PDF file.

All – exports the entire document.

Pages – exports the slide numbers you type in the box. To export a range of slides, use the format 3-6. To export single slides, use the format 7;9;11. You can also export a combination of slide ranges and single slides, by using a format like 3-6;8;10;12.

Selection – exports the current selection of slides.

Images – sets the PDF export options for images inside your document. EPS images with embedded previews are exported only as previews. EPS images without embedded previews are exported as empty placeholders.

Lossless compression – selects a lossless compression of images. All pixels are preserved.

JPEG compression – selects a JPEG compression of images. With a high quality level, almost all pixels are preserved. With a low quality level, some pixels get lost and artifacts are introduced, but file sizes are reduced.

Quality – enter the quality level for JPEG compression.

Reduce image resolution – select to resample or down-size the images to a lower number of pixels per inch. Enter the target resolution for the images.

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 223

General – sets general PDF export options.

Embed OpenDocument file – export the document as a .pdf file containing two file formats: PDF and ODF. In PDF viewers it behaves like a normal PDF file and it remains fully editable in LibreOffice.

PDF/A-1a – convert to the PDF/A-1a format. This is defined as an electronic document file format for long term preservation. All fonts that were used in the source document will be embedded into the generated PDF file. PDF tags will be written.

Tagged PDF – write PDF tags. This can increase file size by huge amounts. A tagged

PDF contains information about the structure of the document contents. This can help to display the document on devices with different screens, and when using screen reader software.

Create PDF form – create a PDF form, which can be filled out and printed by the user of the PDF document.

Submit format – select the format of submitting forms from within the PDF file. Select the format of the data that you will receive from the submitter: FDF (Forms Data

Format), PDF, HTML, or XML. This setting overrides the URL property that you set in the document.

Allow duplicate field names – allows you to use the same field name for multiple fields in the generated PDF file. If disabled, field names will be exported using generated unique names.

Export bookmarks – export bookmarks of Writer documents as PDF bookmarks.

Bookmarks are created for all outline paragraphs (Tools > Outline Numbering) and for all table of contents entries for which you did assign hyperlinks in the source document.

Export comments – export comments in Writer and Calc documents as PDF notes.

Export notes pages – export a set of notes as pages after the set of slides.

Export hidden pages – export any hidden pages in your document as part of the PDF.

Export automatically inserted blank pages – if selected, automatically inserted blank pages are exported in the PDF file. This is best if you are printing the PDF file doublesided. For example, in a book a chapter paragraph style is set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, LibreOffice inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to export that even numbered page.

Embed standard fonts – normally the 14 standard Postscript fonts are not embedded in a PDF file, because PDF reader software already contains these fonts. Enable this option to embed the standard fonts that are installed on your system and that are used in the document. Use this option if you expect to have a better looking or more useful standard font than the font that is available in the recipients' PDF reader software.

Initial View options

On the Initial View page (Figure 189), you can select how the PDF file opens by default in a PDF

viewer.

If you have Complex Text Layout enabled (in Tools > Options > Language settings >

Languages), an additional selection is available under Continuous facing: First page is left.

Normally, the first page is on the right when using the Continuous facing option.

224 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 189: PDF Options dialog – Initial View page

Panes

Page only – generate a PDF file that shows only the page contents.

Bookmarks and page – generate a PDF file that shows a bookmarks palette and the page contents.

Thumbnails and page – generate a PDF file that shows a thumbnails palette and the page contents.

Open on page – show the given page when the reader opens the PDF file.

Magnification

Default – generate a PDF file that shows the page contents without zooming. If the reader software is configured to use a zoom factor by default, the page shows with that zoom factor.

Fit in window – generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit entirely into the window of the PDF file reader.

Fit width – generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit the width of the window of the PDF file reader.

Fit visible – generate a PDF file that shows the text and graphics on the page zoomed to fit the width of the window of the PDF file reader.

Zoom factor – select a zoom factor to apply when the reader opens the PDF file.

Page layout

Default – generate a PDF file that shows the pages according to the layout setting of the reader software.

Single page – generate a PDF file that shows one page at a time.

Continuous – generate a PDF file that shows pages in a continuous vertical column.

Continuous facing – generate PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the right.

First page is left – generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the left. You must enable support for complex text layout in Tools > Options > Language settings >

Languages.

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 225

User Interface options

On the User Interface page (Figure 190), you can choose more settings to control how a PDF

viewer displays the file. Some of these options are particularly useful when you are creating a PDF for use in a presentation or kiosk-type display.

Figure 190: PDF Options dialog – User Interface page

Window options

Resize window to initial page – generate a PDF file that is shown in a window displaying the whole initial page.

Center window on screen – generate a PDF file that is shown in a reader window centered on screen.

Open in full screen mode – generate a PDF file that is shown in a full screen reader window in front of all other windows.

Display document title – generate a PDF file that is shown with the document title in the reader title bar.

User interface options

Hide menu bar – hide the reader's menu bar when the document is active.

Hide toolbar – hide the reader's toolbar when the document is active.

Hide window controls – hide the reader's controls when the document is active.

Transitions

Use transition effects – export Impress slide transition effects to respective PDF effects.

Bookmarks

All bookmark levels – show all bookmark levels when the reader opens the PDF file.

Visible bookmark levels – show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file.

Links options

On the Links page (Figure 191), specify how to export bookmarks and hyperlinks in your

document.

Export bookmarks as named destinations – bookmarks (targets of references) in PDF files can be defined as rectangular areas. Additionally, bookmarks to named objects can be defined by their names. Enable this option to export the names of objects in your document as valid bookmark targets. This allows to link to those objects by name from other documents.

226 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Figure 191: PDF Options dialog – Links page

Convert document references to PDF targets – convert the URLs referencing other ODF files to PDF files with the same name. In referencing URLs the extensions .odt, .odp,

.ods, .odg, and .odm are converted to the extension .pdf.

Export URLs relative to file system – export URLs to other documents as relative URLs in the file system.

Cross-document links – specify how to handle hyperlinks from your PDF file to other files.

Default mode – links from your PDF document to other documents will be handled as specified in your operating system.

Open with PDF reader application – cross-document links are opened with the PDF reader application that currently shows the document. The PDF reader application must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.

Open with Internet browser – cross-document links are opened with the Internet browser. The Internet browser must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.

Security options

On the Security page (Figure 192), you can set PDF export options to encrypt a PDF file so that it

can only be opened using a password and also apply digital rights management (DRM) features.

You have to set a password before the security options are available. Click Set passwords to

open the Set passwords dialog (Figure 193).

Note

Security settings are effective only if another PDF viewer respects the settings.

Figure 192: PDF Options dialog – Security page

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 227

Figure 193: Set Passwords dialog

Set passwords – click to open the Set passwords dialog. You can enter a password to open the file. You can also enter an optional password that allows readers to edit the document.

Printing

Not permitted – printing the document is not permitted.

Low resolution (150 dpi) – the document can only be printed in low resolution (150 dpi).

Not all PDF readers honor this setting.

High resolution – the document can be printed in high resolution.

Changes

Not permitted – no changes of the content are permitted.

Inserting, deleting, and rotating pages – only inserting, deleting, and rotating pages is permitted.

Filling in form fields – only filling in form fields is permitted.

Commenting, filling in form fields – only commenting and filling in form fields is permitted.

Any except extracting pages – all changes are permitted, except extracting pages.

Enable copying of content – select to enable copying of content to the clipboard.

Enable text access for accessibility tools – select to enable text access for accessibility tools.

Flash file export

Macromedia Flash file format (.swf) was created to store animation for web pages. With most browsers able to play Flash movies these files can be viewed by the majority of users. If a browser cannot play Flash movies, then Adobe Flash Player is available as a free download from Adobe at http://www.adobe.com/products/flashplayer/ .

Note

Saving in Flash format does not retain animation and slide transitions.

Using LibreOffice, you can export your Impress slide show as a Flash file in .swf format as follows:

1) Go to File > Export on the menu bar.

2) Select the location where you want the file saved and type a name for the file.

3) Under File Format, select Macromedia Flash (SWF) (.swf) from the drop down list and click Save.

228 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Web pages (HTML files) export

You can export presentations as a series of web pages that can be viewed in any browser.

Note

Saving as web pages (HTML format) does not retain animation and slide transitions.

1) Go to File > Export on the menu bar and select HTML Document (Impress) (.html; .htm) as the file type.

2) Create a folder for the files, then give a name for the resulting HTML file and click Save to

open the HTML Export wizard (Figure 194).

3) Select a design for all of the pages, either from an existing design or by creating a new one. If you have not previously saved a design, the Existing Design choice is not available.

4) Click Next to select the type of web pages to create (Figure 195). The available options will

change depending on publication type selected.

Standard HTML – one page for each slide with navigation links to move from slide to slide.

Standard HTML with frames – one page with a navigation bar on the left-hand side; uses slide title as navigation links. Click on links to display pages in right-hand side.

Automatic – one page for each slide, with each page set with the refresh meta tag so a browser automatically cycles from one page to the next.

WebCast – generates an ASP or Perl application to display the slides. Unfortunately

LibreOffice has no direct support for PHP yet.

5) Click Next to decide how the images will be saved (PNG, GIF or JPG) and what resolution

to use (Figure 196). When choosing a resolution, consider what the majority of your

viewers may have. For example, if you use a high resolution, then a viewer with a mediumresolution monitor will have to scroll sideways to see the entire slide.

6) If Create title page was selected in Step 4, supply the information for the title page on the

next page that appears after clicking Next (Figure 197). The title page contains name of the

author, e-mail address and home page, along with any additional information you want to include. This page of the Wizard does not display if Create title page was not selected.

Figure 194: HTML Export wizard – selecting a design

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 229

Figure 195: HTML Export – selecting publication type

Figure 196: HTML Export – selecting graphics type

230

Figure 197: HTML Export – title page information

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

7) Click Next to select the style of navigation buttons to use when moving from one page to

another (Figure 198). If you do not choose a navigation style, LibreOffice will create a text

navigator.

Figure 198: HTML Export – selecting navigation style

8) Click Next to select the color scheme for the web pages (Figure 199). Available schemes

include the existing scheme for the presentation, one based upon browser colors, and a user-defined scheme. You can save a new scheme so that it will appear on the first page of the HTML export wizard.

Figure 199: HTML Export – selecting color scheme

9) Click Create to generate the HTML files. If this is a new design, a dialog opens so you can save the design. If you want to reuse this design, you can give it a name and save it.

Otherwise, click Do Not Save.

E-mailing a presentation

LibreOffice provides several ways to quickly and easily send a presentation as an e-mail attachment in one of three formats: ODP (OpenDocument Presentation, the LibreOffice default format), PPT (Microsoft PowerPoint format), or as a PDF file.

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 231

1) To send the presentation in ODP format, go to File > Send > Document as E-mail or File

> Send > E-mail as OpenDocument Presentation on the menu bar. LibreOffice opens a new e-mail in your e-mail program with the ODP document attached.

To send the presentation in PPT format, go to File > Send > E-mail as Microsoft

PowerPoint Presentation on the menu bar. LibreOffice creates a PPT file and then opens a new e-mail in your e-mail program with the PPT file attached. This PPT file is not saved on your computer.

To send the presentation in PDF format, go to File > Send > E-mail as PDF on the menu bar. LibreOffice first creates a PDF using your default PDF settings (similar to using the

Export Directly as PDF icon in the standard toolbar) and then opens a new e-mail in your e-mail program with the PDF file attached. This PDF file is not saved on your computer.

2) In your e-mail program, enter the recipient, subject and any text you want to add, then send the e-mail.

Tip

If you want to keep a copy of the .PPT or .PDF file as well as e-mailing it to someone, first save or export the presentation into the required format, then attach it to an e-mail in the usual way.

Digital signing of documents

To sign a document digitally, you need a personal key, also known as a certificate. A personal key is stored on your computer as a combination of a private key, which must be kept secret, and a public key, which you add to your documents when you sign them. You can get a certificate from a certification authority, which may be a private company or a governmental institution.

When you apply a digital signature to a document, a kind of checksum is computed from the document contents plus your personal key. The checksum and your public key are stored together with the document.

When someone later opens the document on any computer with a recent version of LibreOffice, the program will compute the checksum again and compare it with the stored checksum. If both are the same, the program will signal that you see the original, unchanged document. In addition, the program can show you the public key information from the certificate. You can compare the public key with the public key that is published on the web site of the certificate authority.

Whenever someone changes something in the document, this change breaks the digital signature.

On Windows operating systems, the Windows features for validating a signature are used. On

GNU/Linux systems, files that are supplied by Thunderbird, Mozilla, or Firefox are used. For a more detailed description of how to get and manage a certificate, and signature validation, see

“About Digital Signatures” and “Applying Digital Signatures” in the LibreOffice Help.

To digitally sign a document:

1) Go to File > Digital Signatures on the menu bar.

2) If you have not saved the document since the last change, a message appears. Click Yes to save the file.

3) After saving, the Digital Signatures dialog opens. Click Sign Document to add a public key to the document.

4) In the Select Certificate dialog, select your certificate and click OK to close the dialog.

5) If necessary, repeat Steps 3 and 4 to add more certificates.

6) Click OK to add the public key to the saved file. When a document is digitally signed, an indicator appears on the status bar. You can double-click the icon to view the certificate.

232 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Removing personal data

You may wish to ensure that personal data, versions, notes, hidden information, or recorded changes are removed from files before you send them to other people or create PDF files from them.

In Tools > Options > LibreOffice > Security > Options, you can set LibreOffice to remind (warn) you when files contain certain information and remove personal information automatically when saving the file or when creating a PDF.

To remove personal and some other data from a file, go to File > Properties. On the General tab, uncheck Apply user data and then click the Reset button. This removes any names in the created and modified fields, deletes the modification and printing dates, and resets the editing time to zero, the creation date to the current date and time, and the version number to 1. Make sure you click

OK to save the changes.

Opening and saving a PowerPoint file

The file format of LibreOffice Impress is highly compatible with the format used by Microsoft

PowerPoint. You can open a PowerPoint presentation in Impress, edit it, then save it in its original

PowerPoint format or in OpenDocument Presentation format used by Impress. You can also create a new presentation in Impress and save it as a PowerPoint file.

Note

There are some differences between OpenDocument (.odp) and PowerPoint (.ppt,

.pptx) files in text and graphics formatting, animations, transitions, and fields. For best results, avoid using features that are not fully supported in both formats.

Saving an Impress file as a PowerPoint file

1) Go to File > Save As on the menu bar.

2) Select the location where you want the PowerPoint file saved and type a name for the file.

3) Under File type, select a Microsoft PowerPoint format (.ppt or .pptx) from the available drop-down list.

4) Click Save. If you have the “Warn when not saving in ODF or default format” option set in

Tools > Options > Load/Save > General, a Confirm file Format dialog (Figure 200) opens.

Click on the button showing the Microsoft PowerPoint format to confirm that you want to save the file in that format. You can deselect the Ask when not saving in ODF format checkbox to not show the message again unless you re-enable it in the options.

Figure 200: Confirm file Format dialog

Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows 233

Tip

Always save your work in Impress OpenDocument format (.odp) before saving in

Microsoft format. Keep the Impress file as your working copy: if you need to change the presentation, change it in the Impress version and then save it again as

PowerPoint. You are much less likely to have problems than if you open a file previously saved in PowerPoint format, edit it, and save it again.

Opening a PowerPoint file in Impress

If you receive a file from someone in PowerPoint format and need to edit it in Impress, here is how:

1) In LibreOffice, go to File > Open on the menu bar.

2) In File type, select All files (*.*) or Presentations or Microsoft PowerPoint from the dropdown list.

3) Navigate to the PowerPoint file, select it, and click Open.

The PowerPoint file can now be edited and saved as an Impress file or as a PowerPoint file. To save the file as an Impress file, select Open Document Presentation (.odp) as the file type.

234 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Chapter

11

Setting Up and Customizing

Impress

LibreOffice options

This section covers some of the settings that apply to all the components of LibreOffice and are of interest to users of Impress. Other general options are discussed in Getting Started Guide Chapter

2 Setting Up LibreOffice.

1) Go to Tools > Options (LibreOffice > Preferences on a Mac) on the menu bar to open the Options dialog. The list on the left-hand side of the Options dialog varies depending on which component of LibreOffice is open. The illustrations in this chapter show the list as it appears when Impress is open.

2) Click the expansion marker (+ or triangle) by LibreOffice on the left-hand side. A list of subsections drops down.

Figure 201: Options – LibreOffice – User Data dialog

Note

The Revert button has the same effect on all pages of the Options dialog. It resets the options to the values that were in place when you opened LibreOffice.

User Data options

Impress uses the first and last name stored in the User Data to fill in the Created by and Modified

by fields in document properties, the optional Author field used in the footer of a presentation, and the name associated with comments. If you want your name to appear, then do the following:

1) In the Options dialog, click LibreOffice > User Data (Figure 201).

2) Fill in the Address form with your details and/or delete any existing incorrect information.

Print options

In the Options dialog, click LibreOffice > Print (Figure 202) to set the print options that suit your

default printer and your most common printing method.

236 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

You can change these settings at any time, either through the Options dialog or during the printing process. See Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving Slide Shows in this guide for more information about the printing options available.

Figure 202: Options – LibreOffice – Print dialog

Color options

In the Options dialog, click LibreOffice > Colors to specify colors used in LibreOffice documents.

You can select a color from a color table, edit an existing color, or define new colors. These colors are stored in your color selection palette and are then available in all components of LibreOffice.

You can also define colors within Impress by going to Format > Area on the menu bar, or through the Line and Filling toolbar, but those colors will not be available to other components of

LibreOffice.

Figure 203. Options – LibreOffice – Colors dialog

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 237

Appearance options

In the Options dialog, click LibreOffice > Appearance to specify which items are visible and the colors used to display various elements of the user interface.

The only option specific to Impress (and Draw) is the color of the grid points. Scroll down in the page until you find Drawing/Presentation. To change the default color for grid points, click the down-arrow by the color and select a new color from the pop-up dialog.

If you wish to save your color changes as a color scheme, click Save, type a name in the Save

scheme dialog, then click OK.

Figure 204. Options – LibreOffice – Appearance dialog

Figure 205: Options – LibreOffice Impress – General dialog

238 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Choosing options for Impress

In the Options dialog, click the expansion marker to the left of LibreOffice Impress on the left-

hand side. A list of subsections for Impress drops down (Figure 205).

General options

In the Options dialog, click LibreOffice Impress > General (Figure 205) to specify the general

options for presentation documents.

Text objects

Allow quick editing – if selected, you can edit text immediately after clicking a text object.

If deselected, you must double-click to edit text. In a presentation, you can also activate the text editing mode using the Allow Quick Editing icon

on the Option toolbar (Figure

206).

Figure 206: Options toolbar

Only text area selectable – specifies whether to select a text frame by clicking the text. In the area of the text frame that is not filled with text, an object behind the text frame can be selected. In a presentation, you can also activate this mode using the Select Text Area

Only icon on the Option toolbar.

New document

Start with Wizard – specifies whether to activate the Presentation Wizard when creating a new presentation using File > New > Presentation on the menu bar.

Settings

Use background cache – specifies whether to use the cache for displaying objects on the master page. This speeds up the display. Deselect this option if you want to display changing contents on the master page.

Copy when moving – if selected, a copy is created when you move an object while holding down the Ctrl key. The same will apply for rotating and resizing the object. The original object will remain in its current position and size.

Objects always moveable – specifies that you want to move an object with the Rotate tool enabled. If this option is not selected, the Rotate tool can only be used to rotate an object.

Unit of measurement – determines the unit of measurement used for presentations.

Tab stops – defines the spacing between tab stops.

Presentation

Always with current page – specifies that you always want a presentation to start with the current slide. When this option is not selected, a presentation always starts with the first page.

Enable remote control – specifies that you want to enable Bluetooth remote control while

Impress is running. Deselect this option to disable remote control.

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 239

Compatibility

The settings in this area are valid for the current document only.

Use printer metrics for document formatting – specifies that printer metrics are applied for printing and also for formatting the display on the screen. If this option is not selected, a printer independent layout will be used for screen display and printing. If you set this option for the current document and then save the document, for example, in an older binary format, this option will not be saved. If you later open the file from the older format, this option will be set by default.

Add spacing between paragraphs in the current document – specifies that Impress calculates the paragraph spacing exactly like Microsoft PowerPoint. Microsoft PowerPoint adds the bottom spacing of a paragraph to the top spacing of the next paragraph to calculate the total spacing between both paragraphs. Impress utilizes only the larger of the two spacings.

View options

In the Options dialog, click on LibreOffice Impress > View (Figure 207) to specify the available

display modes. By selecting an alternative display, you can speed up the screen display while editing your presentation.

Figure 207: Options – LibreOffice Impress – View dialog

Rulers visible – specifies whether to display the rulers at the top and to the left of the work area.

Snap Lines when moving – specifies whether to display guides when moving an object.

Impress creates dotted guides that extend beyond the box containing the selected object and which cover the entire work area, helping you position the object. You also can use this function using the Helplines While Moving icon

on the Options toolbar (Figure 206) if

a presentation is open.

All control points in Bézier editor – displays the control points of all Bézier points if you have previously selected a Bézier curve. If this option is not selected, only the control points of the selected Bézier points will be visible.

Contour of each individual object – Impress displays the contour line of each individual object when moving this object. This option enables you to see if single objects conflict with other objects in the target position. If you do not select this option, Impress displays only a square contour that includes all selected objects.

Grid options

In the Options dialog, click LibreOffice Impress > Grid (Figure 208) to specify the grid settings for

Impress. Using a grid helps you determine the exact position of your objects. You can also set this grid to line up with the snap grid.

240 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

If you have activated the snap grid, but wish to move or create individual objects without snap positions, keep the Shift key pressed to deactivate this function for as long as needed.

Figure 208: Options – LibreOffice Impress – Grid dialog

Grid

Snap to grid – activates the snap function. If this option is selected, but you want to move or create individual objects without snapping to the grid, press the Shift key to deactivate

Snap to grid whilst moving the individual object. You can also use the Snap to Grid icon

on the Options toolbar (Figure 206).

Visible grid: displays grid points on the screen. These points will not display or print as part of a presentation.

Resolution

Horizontal – defines the unit of measure for the spacing between grid points on the X-axis.

Vertical – defines the grid points spacing in the desired unit of measurement on the Y-axis.

Synchronize axes – specifies whether to change the current grid settings symmetrically.

The resolution and subdivision for the X and Y axes remain the same.

Subdivision

Horizontal – specify the number of intermediate spaces between grid points on the X-axis.

Vertical – specify the number of intermediate spaces between grid points on the Y-axis.

Snap

To snap lines – snaps the edge of an object being dragged to the nearest snap line when you release the mouse. You can also define this setting by using the Snap to Snap Lines icon

on the Options toolbar (Figure 206).

To the page margins – specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the nearest page margin. The cursor or a contour line of the graphics object must be in the snap range. In a presentation, this function can also be accessed with the Snap to Page

Margins icon on the Options toolbar.

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 241

To object frame – specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the border of the nearest graphic object. The cursor or a contour line of the graphics object must be in the snap range. In a presentation, this function can also be accessed with the Snap to

Object Border icon on the Options toolbar.

To object points – specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the points of the nearest graphic object. This only applies if the cursor or a contour line of the graphics object is in the snap range. In a presentation, this function can also be accessed with the

Snap to Object Points icon on the Options toolbar.

Snap range – defines the snap distance between the mouse pointer and the object contour. LibreOffice Impress snaps to a snap point if the mouse cursor is nearer than the distance specified.

Snap position

When creating or moving objects – specifies that graphic objects are restricted vertically, horizontally or diagonally (45°) when creating or moving them. You can temporarily deactivate this setting by pressing the Shift key.

Extend edges – specifies that a square is created based on the longer side of a rectangle when the Shift key is pressed before you release the mouse button. This also applies to an ellipse (a circle will be created based on the longest diameter of the ellipse). When this option is not selected, a square or a circle will be created based on the shorter side or diameter.

When rotating – specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected. If you want to rotate an object outside the defined angle, press the Shift key when rotating. Release the key when the desired rotation angle is reached.

Point reduction – defines the angle for point reduction. When working with polygons, you might find it useful to reduce their editing points.

Print options

In the Options dialog, click on LibreOffice Impress > Print (Error: Reference source not found) to

specify print settings for a presentation. See Chapter 10 Printing, E-mailing, Exporting, and Saving

Slide Shows for more information about the options available.

Figure 209: Options – LibreOffice Impress – Print dialog

242 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Quality

Default – specifies that you want to print in original colors.

Grayscale – specifies that you want to print colors as grayscale.

Black & white – specifies that you want to print the document in black and white.

Print

Page name – specifies whether to print the page name.

Date – specifies whether to print the current date.

Time – specifies whether to print the current time.

Hidden pages – specifies whether to print the pages that are currently hidden from the presentation.

Page options

Default – specifies that you do not want to further scale pages when printing.

Fit to page – specifies whether to scale down objects that are beyond the margins of the current printer so that they fit on the paper in the printer.

Tile pages – specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper.

Brochure – select this option to print the document in brochure format. You can also decide if you want to print the front, the back or both sides of the brochure.

Front – select this option to print the front of a brochure.

Back – select this option to print the back of a brochure.

Paper tray from printer settings – determines that the paper tray to be used is the one defined in the printer setup.

Customizing the user interface

Menu font

If you want to change the menu font from that supplied by LibreOffice to the system font for your operating system:

1) Go to Tools > Options > LibreOffice > View on the menu bar.

2) Select Use system font for user interface and click OK.

Menu content

You can customize the menus in Impress by adding and rearranging items on the menu bar, adding items to menus, and other changes.

1) Go to View > Toolbars > Customize or Tools > Customize on the menu bar to open the

Customize dialog (Figure 210).

2) Make sure the Menus page is open.

3) In the Save In drop-down list, select whether to save this customized menu in LibreOffice

Impress or for a presentation.

4) In the section LibreOffice Impress Menus, select from the Menu drop-down list the menu that you want to customize.

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 243

5) To customize the selected menu, click on the Menu or Modify buttons. You can also add commands to a menu by clicking on the Add button. These actions are described in the following sections. Use the up and down arrows next to the Entries list to move the selected menu item to a different position.

6) When you have finished making all your changes, click OK to save them.

Figure 210. Customize dialog – Menus page

244

Figure 211: New Menu dialog

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Creating new menus

To create a new menu:

1) On the Menus page of the Customize dialog, click New to open the New Menu dialog

(Figure 211).

2) Type a name for your new menu in the Menu name box.

3) Use the up and down arrow buttons to move the new menu into the required position on the menu bar.

4) Click OK to save. The new menu now appears on the list of menus in the Customize dialog. It will appear on the menu bar itself after you save your customizations.

5) After creating a new menu, you need to add some commands to it, as described in “Adding menu commands” on page 246.

Modifying existing menus

To modify an existing menu:

1) On the Menus page of the Customize dialog and select the menu you want to modify from the Menu drop down list.

2) Click Menu to open a list of modifications: Move, Rename, Delete. Only Move is available in the list. Rename and Delete are not available for the default menus within LibreOffice.

3) To move a menu (for example File), select Menu > Move to open the Move Menu dialog

(Figure 212).

4) Use the up and down arrow buttons to move the menu into the required position.

5) To move submenus (for example File | Send), select the main menu (File) in the Menu list

and then, in the Menu Content section of the Customize dialog (Figure 210), select the

submenu Send in the Entries list and use the arrow keys to move it up or down in the sequence.

6) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Figure 212: Move Menu dialog

Creating keyboard shortcuts

In addition to renaming a menu, you can specify a keyboard shortcut that allows you to select a menu command when you press Alt key plus an underlined letter in a menu command.

1) Select a menu or menu entry.

2) Click Modify in the Customize dialog (Figure 210) and select Rename.

3) Add a tilde (~) in front of the letter that you want to use as an accelerator. For example, to select the Save All command by pressing Alt+V, enter Sa~ve All.

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 245

Note

Be careful when creating new keyboard shortcuts. In the example above, if the File menu is not already open, then pressing Alt+V opens the View menu. If another menu is open, Alt+V might activate some other command.

Adding menu commands

You can add commands to menus and to menus you have created.

1) On the Menus page of the Customize dialog (Figure 210), select the menu in the Menu list

and click Add.

Figure 213: Add Commands dialog

2) In the Add Commands dialog (Figure 213), select a category and then the command, and

click Add. The dialog remains open, so you can select additional commands.

3) When you have finished adding commands, click Close.

4) In the Customize dialog, use the up and down arrow buttons to arrange the commands in your preferred sequence.

5) Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Modifying menu entries

In addition to changing the sequence of entries on a menu or submenu, you can add submenus, rename or delete the entries, and add group separators.

1) On the Menus page of the Customize dialog (Figure 210), select the menu in the Menu list

you want to modify.

2) Select an entry in the Entries list under Menu Content.

3) Click the Modify button and choose the required action from the drop-down list of actions.

Most of the actions are self-explanatory. Begin a group adds a separator line after the highlighted entry.

246 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Customizing toolbars

You can customize toolbars in several ways, including choosing which icons are visible, and locking the position of a docked toolbar, as described in Getting Started Guide Chapter 1,

Introducing LibreOffice. This section describes how to create new toolbars and add other icons

(commands) to the list of those available on a toolbar.

Customize toolbars

1) Go to View > Toolbars > Customize or Tools > Customize on the menu bar, or right-click in an empty area on the toolbar and select Customize Toolbar from the context menu, to

open the Customize dialog (Figure 214).

Figure 214. Customize dialog – Toolbars page

2) Make sure the Toolbars page is open.

3) In the Save In drop-down list, select whether to save this customized toolbar for Impress or for a selected presentation.

4) In the LibreOffice Impress Toolbars section, select from the Toolbar drop-down list the toolbar that you want to customize.

5) Click Toolbar on the right to display a drop-down list of options for customizing the toolbar.

6) Select the option you want to use from the context menu. Icons Only is the default setting for toolbars.

7) To display or hide commands, select or deselect the checkboxes in Commands in the

Toolbar Content section.

8) To change the position of commands on a toolbar, select a command and click the up and down arrows to the right of the list.

9) When you have finished customizing a toolbar, click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 247

Creating new toolbars

To create a new toolbar:

1) Go to View > Toolbars > Customize or Tools > Customize on the menu bar, or right-click in an empty area on the toolbar and select Customize Toolbar from the context menu, to

open the Customize dialog (Figure 214).

2) Make sure the Toolbars page is open.

3) Click New to open the Name dialog (Figure 215).

4) Type a name for the new toolbar and select from the Save In drop-down list where to save this new menu for Impress or for a selected document.

Figure 215: Name dialog for new toolbars

5) Click OK and the new toolbar now appears on the list of toolbars in the Customize dialog.

After creating a new toolbar, you have to add some commands to it, as described below.

Adding toolbar commands

To add commands to a new toolbar or to customize an existing toolbar:

1) Go to View > Toolbars > Customize or Tools > Customize on the menu bar, or right-click in an empty area on the toolbar and select Customize Toolbar from the context menu, to open the Customize dialog.

2) Make sure the Toolbars page is open (Figure 214).

3) Select the toolbar from the Toolbar drop down list.

4) Click Add to open the Add Commands dialog (Figure 213 on page 246) and is the same dialog used for adding commands to menus (“Adding menu commands” on page 246).

5) Select a Category and then a Command from the relevant list.

6) Click Add. The Add Commands dialog remains open, so you can select additional commands.

7) When you have finished adding commands, click Close. If you insert an item which does not have an associated icon, the toolbar will display the full name of the item; see

“Choosing icons for toolbar commands” below on how to choose an icon for a toolbar

command.

8) On the Customize dialog, use the up and down arrow buttons to arrange the commands in your preferred sequence.

9) When you have finished making changes, click OK to save and close the dialog.

Choosing icons for toolbar commands

Toolbars usually have icons and not words to indicate commands, but not all commands have associated icons.

1) Select the command and click Modify and select Change icon on the context menu to

open the Change Icon dialog (Figure 216).

2) Scroll through the available icons and select the one you want to use.

3) Click OK to assign it to the command.

248 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Note

Figure 216: Change Icon dialog

To use a custom icon, create it in a graphics program and then import it into

LibreOffice by clicking Import on the Change Icon dialog. Custom icons must be

16×16 or 26×26 pixels in size and cannot contain more than 256 colors.

Customizing keyboard shortcuts

The Appendix to this guide lists the default keyboard shortcuts supplied with Impress. You can change these defaults or add new shortcuts. You can assign shortcuts to standard Impress functions or your own macros and save them for use with Impress only or with the LibreOffice suite.

Caution

Be careful when reassigning predefined shortcut keys used in your operating system or LibreOffice. Many key assignments are universally understood shortcuts, such as

F1 for Help, and are always expected to provide certain results. Although you can easily reset the shortcut key assignments to LibreOffice defaults, changing some common shortcut keys can cause confusion, frustration and possible data loss or corruption, especially if other users share your computer.

Example shortcut key

For example, suppose you wish to assign a shortcut key to easily insert a duplicate slide in your presentation. You could assign the Insert key as a logical shortcut for this purpose, as described below.

1) Go to View > Toolbars > Customize or Tools > Customize on the menu bar, or go to on the menu bar, or right-click in an empty area on the toolbar and select Customize Toolbar from the context menu to open the Customize dialog.

2) Make sure the Keyboard page is open (Figure 217).

3) As the shortcut key assignment is only relevant with Impress and not LibreOffice, select

Impress in the upper right corner of the dialog.

4) Select Insert in the Category list and Duplicate Slide in the Function list.

5) Select the shortcut key Insert in the Shortcut keys list and click Modify.

6) Click OK to accept the change. Now the Insert key will insert a duplicate slide immediately after the currently selected slide.

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 249

Note

Figure 217: Customize dialog – Keyboard page

All existing shortcut keys for the currently selected Function are listed in the Keys selection box. Since there was no currently assigned shortcut for the Insert >

Duplicate Slide function the Keys list was empty. If it had not been, and you wished to reassign a shortcut key combination that was already in use, you would first have to Delete the existing key.

Shortcut keys not available for reassignment are greyed out in the listing on the

Customize dialog, for example F1 and F10.

Saving changes

Changes to the shortcut key assignments (and other configurations) can be saved in a keyboard configuration file for use at a later time. This allows you to create and apply different configurations as the need arises.

1) After making your keyboard shortcut assignments, click Save in the Customize dialog.

2) In the Save Keyboard Configuration dialog that opens, select All files from the Save as

Type list.

3) Enter a name for the keyboard configuration file in the File name box, or select an existing file from the list. If you need to, browse to find a file from another location.

4) Click Save. A confirmation dialog will appear if you are about to overwrite an existing file; otherwise there will be no feedback and the file will be saved.

250 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Loading saved keyboard configurations

To load a saved keyboard configuration file and replace your existing configuration, click Load in the Customize dialog and then select the configuration file from the Load Keyboard Configuration dialog.

Resetting shortcut keys

To reset all of the keyboard shortcuts to their default values, click Reset in the Customize dialog.

Use this feature with care as no confirmation dialog will be displayed and the defaults will be set without any further notice or user input.

Running macros from key combinations

You can also define shortcut key combinations that will run macros. These shortcut keys are strictly user-defined and no macro shortcut keys are supplied with LibreOffice. For information on macros, see the Getting Started Guide, Chapter 13 Getting started with macros.

Adding functions with extensions

An extension is a package that can be installed into LibreOffice to add a new function.

Although individual extensions can be found in different places, the official LibreOffice extension repository is at http://extensions.libreoffice.org/ . Some extensions are free of charge; others are available for a fee. Check the descriptions to see what licenses and fees apply to the ones that interest you.

Figure 218: Extension Manager dialog

Chapter 11 Setting Up and Customizing Impress 251

Installing extensions

To install an extension, follow these steps:

1) Download the extension and save it anywhere on your computer.

2) In LibreOffice, go to Tools > Extension Manager on the menu bar to open the Extension

Manager dialog (Figure 218).

3) Click Add and a file browser window opens. Find and select the extension you want to install and click Open. The extension begins installing. You may be asked to accept a license agreement.

4) When the installation is complete, the extension is listed in the Extension Manager dialog.

Tip

To get extensions that are listed in the repository, you can open the Extension

Manager and click the Get more extensions online link.

Note

To install a shared extension, you need write access to the LibreOffice installation directory.

Using extensions

This section describes some of the more important and popular extensions to Impress. In each case, you need to first install the extension as described in the previous section.

Presenter Console

This is bundled with most installations of LibreOffice and provides extra control over slide shows

(presentations). For example, the Presenter Console has the ability to see the next slide in the presentation, slide notes, and a presentation timer, while the audience only sees the slide currently being displayed. The Presenter Console displays the elements in three easily changeable views:

First view displays the current slide, including the effects, and the next slide.

Second view shows notes for the speaker in large, clear, and scalable type, plus the current and next slide.

Third view is a slide sorter view with the slide thumbnails.

The Presenter Console is only available for use if you have a second display connected to your computer. See Chapter 9, Slide Shows for more information about using the Presenter Console.

Note

The Presenter Console works only on an operating system that supports multiple displays and only when two displays are connected (one may be the laptop built-in display).

Professional Template Pack II

Provides more than 120 templates for Writer, Calc, and Impress. Available in several languages.

After you have installed this extension, you will find the templates in the Template Manager, reached from File > New > Templates on the menu bar.

Presentation Minimizer

Reduces the file size of the current presentation. Images are compressed and data that is no longer needed is removed. Can also optimize the image quality size. Presentations designed for screen or projector do not require the same high quality as presentations designed for print.

252 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Appendix

A

Keyboard Shortcuts

Introduction

You can use LibreOffice without requiring a pointing device, such as a mouse or trackball, by using its built-in keyboard shortcuts. Tasks as varied and complex as docking and un-docking toolbars and windows, or changing the size or position of objects can all be accomplished with only a keyboard. Although LibreOffice has its own extensive set of keyboard shortcuts, each component provides others which are specific to its work.

For help with LibreOffice’s keyboard shortcuts, or using LibreOffice with a keyboard only, search the LibreOffice Help using the “shortcut” or “accessibility” keywords.

In addition to using the built-in keyboard shortcuts (listed in this Appendix), you can also define your own. You can assign shortcuts to standard Impress functions or your own macros and save them for use with Impress only, or with the entire LibreOffice suite.

To adapt shortcut keys to your needs, use the Customize dialog as described in this section and in

“Customizing keyboard shortcuts” in Chapter 11, Setting Up and Customizing Impress.

Tip for Macintosh users

Some keystrokes are different on a Mac from those used in Windows and Linux. The following table gives some common substitutions for the instructions in this book. For a more detailed list, see the application Help.

Windows or Linux Mac equivalent

Tools > Options menu selection

LibreOffice > Preferences

Right-click

Control+click and/or right-click depending on computer setup

Ctrl (Control)

F5

F11

(Command)

Shift+

⌘+F5

⌘+T

Effect

Access setup options

Open a context menu

Used with other keys

Open the Navigator

Open the Styles and Formatting window

Note

Some of the shortcut keys in this appendix may be assigned to your desktop system.

Keys that are assigned to the desktop system are not available to LibreOffice. Try to assign different keys either for LibreOffice in Tools > Customize > Keyboard, or in your computer system.

Impress function keys

Shortcut Keys

F2

F3

Shift+F3

Ctrl+F3

F4

F5

Effect

Select text tool and edit text.

Enter group and edit group.

Duplicate object.

Exit group.

Open Position and Size dialog.

View slide show.

254 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Shortcut Keys

Ctrl+Shift+F5

F6

Shift+F6

Ctrl+F6

F7

Ctrl+F7

F8

Ctrl+Shift+F8

Shift+F10

F11

Effect

Open Navigator.

Forward toolbar navigation without using mouse.

Backward toolbar navigation without using mouse.

Enter a document.

Start spelling checker.

Open thesaurus.

Edit points.

Fit text to frame.

Open context menu of a selected object.

Open Styles and Formatting dialog.

Slide show shortcut keys

Shortcut Keys

Esc

Spacebar or Right arrow or Down arrow or Page

Down or Enter or Return or N

Alt+Page Down

[number] + Enter

Left arrow or Up arrow or

Page Up or Backspace or

P

Alt+Page Up

Home

End

Ctrl+Page Up

Ctrl+Page Down

B or .

W or ,

Effect

End presentation.

Play the next effect on the slide. If no previous effect exists on this slide, go to next slide.

Go to next slide without playing effects.

Type the number of a slide and press Enter to go to the slide.

Play previous effect again. If no previous effect exists on this slide, show previous slide.

Go to the previous slide without playing effects.

Jump to first slide in the slide show.

Jump to the last slide in the slide show.

Go to the previous slide.

Go to the next slide.

Show black screen until next key or mouse wheel event.

Show white screen until next key or mouse wheel event.

Appendix A Keyboard Shortcuts 255

Normal view shortcut keys

Shortcut Keys

Plus(+)

Minus(-)

Times(×) (number pad)

Divide(÷) (number pad)

Shift+Ctrl+G

Shift+Ctrl+Alt+A

Ctrl+click

Shift+Ctrl+K

Shift+Ctrl+K

Ctrl++Plus(+)

Shift+Ctrl+Plus(+)

Ctrl+Minus(-)

Shift+Ctrl+Minus(-)

Effect

Zoom in.

Zoom out.

Fit page in window.

Zoom in on current selection.

Group selected objects.

Ungroup selected group.

Enter a group, so that you can edit the individual objects of the group. Click outside the group to return to the normal view.

Combine selected objects.

Split selected object. This keyboard combination only works on an object that was created by combining two or more objects.

Bring to front.

Bring forward.

Send backward.

Send to back.

Editing text shortcut keys

Shortcut Keys

Ctrl+Hyphen(-)

Ctrl+Shift+Minus(-)

Ctrl+Shift+Space

Shift+Enter

Left arrow

Shift+Left arrow

Ctrl+Left arrow

Ctrl+Shift+left arrow

Right arrow

Shift+Right arrow

Ctrl+Right arrow

Ctrl+Shift+Right arrow

Up arrow

Shift+Up arrow

Ctrl+Up arrow

Effect

Custom hyphens; hyphenation set by you.

Non-breaking dash and is not used for hyphenation.

Non-breaking spaces. Non-breaking spaces are not used for hyphenation and are not expanded if the text is justified.

Line break without paragraph change.

Move cursor to the left.

Move cursor with selection to the left.

Go to beginning of a word.

Select to the left word by word.

Move cursor to the right.

Move cursor with selection to the right.

Go to beginning of next word.

Select to the right word by word.

Move cursor up one line.

Selecting lines going upwards in the document.

Move cursor to the beginning of the paragraph.

256 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

Shortcut Keys

Ctrl+Shift+Up arrow

Down arrow

Shift+Down arrow

Ctrl+Down arrow

Ctrl+Shift+Down arrow

Home

Shift+Home

Ctrl+Home

Ctrl+Shift+Home

End

Shift+End

Ctrl+End

Ctrl+Shift+End

Ctrl+Del

Ctrl+Shift+Del

Ctrl+Backspace

Ctrl+Shift+Backspace

Effect

Select to beginning of paragraph. Next keystroke extends selection to beginning of previous paragraph.

Move cursor down one line.

Selecting lines going downwards in the document.

Move cursor to end of paragraph.

Select to end of paragraph. Next keystroke extends selection to end of next paragraph.

Go to beginning of line.

Go to and select to the beginning of a line.

Go to start of text block in slide.

Go to and select to the beginning of text block in slide.

Go to end of line.

Go to and select to end of a line.

Go to end of text block in a slide.

Go to and select to the end of text block in a slide.

Delete text to end of word.

Delete text to end of sentence.

Delete text to beginning of word. In a list, delete an empty paragraph in front of current paragraph.

Delete text to beginning of sentence.

Impress shortcut keys

Shortcut Keys

Arrow

Ctrl+Arrow

Shift+drag

Ctrl+drag

Alt+drag

Alt+click

Alt+Shift+click

Shift+click

Shift+drag

Effect

Move the selected object or the page view in the direction of the arrow.

Move the slide in the normal view.

Constrain the movement of the selected object horizontally or vertically.

Hold down Ctrl and drag an object to create a copy of the object.

Hold down Alt to draw or resize objects by dragging from the centre of the object outward.

Select the object behind the currently selected object.

Select the object in front of the currently selected object.

Select adjacent items or a text passage. Click at the start of a selection, move to the end of the selection, and then hold down Shift while you click.

Hold down Shift while dragging to resize an object to maintain the proportions of the object.

Appendix A Keyboard Shortcuts 257

Shortcut Keys

Tab

Shift+Tab

Escape

Enter

Ctrl+Enter

Page Up

Page Down

Effect

Select objects in the order in which they were created.

Select objects in the reverse order in which they were created.

Exit current mode.

Activate a place-holder object in a new presentation (only if the frame is selected).

Move to the next text object on the slide. If there are no text objects on the slide, or if you reached the last text object, a new slide is inserted after the current slide. The new slide uses the same layout as the current slide.

Switch to the previous slide. No function on the first slide.

Switch to the next slide. No function on the last slide.

Slide Sorter navigation

Shortcut Keys

Escape

Arrow key

Spacebar

Effect

Moves the focus to the first slide.

Moves the focus to the next slide.

Makes the slide with focus the current slide.

Using shortcut keys

Some of the shortcut keys may be assigned to your desktop system. Keys that are assigned to the desktop system are not available to LibreOffice. Try to assign different keys either for LibreOffice, in Tools > Customize > Keyboard, or in your computer system.

You can use the keyboard to access LibreOffice Impress commands as well as to navigate through the workspace. LibreOffice Impress uses the same shortcut keys as LibreOffice Draw to create drawing objects.

The following sections give examples on using shortcut keys.

Selecting placeholders

AutoLayouts in LibreOffice Impress use placeholders for slide titles, text, and objects. To select a placeholder, press Ctrl+Enter. To move to the next placeholder, press Ctrl+Enter again.

If you press Ctrl+Enter after you reach the last placeholder in a slide, a new slide is inserted after the current slide. The new slide uses the same layout as the current slide.

Creating and editing drawing objects

5) Press F6 repeatedly until the Drawing toolbar is active.

6) Press the Right or Left arrow key until you reach the toolbar icon of a drawing tool.

7) If there is an arrow next to the icon, the drawing tool opens a sub toolbar. Press the Up or

Down arrow key to open the sub toolbar.

258 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

8) Press the Right or Left arrow key to select an icon.

9) Press Ctrl+Enter and the object is created at the center of the current slide.

10) To return to the document, press Ctrl+F6.

11) Use the arrow keys to position the object where you want.

12) To select a command from the context menu for the object, press Shift+F10 to open the context menu.

13) Use the Up or Down arrow to select the command.

14) Press Enter to execute the command.

15) Press Esc key to exit

Selecting objects

1) Press Ctrl+F6 to enter the document.

2) Press Tab until you reach the object you want to select.

Slide show

1) To start a slide show, press Ctrl+F2 or F5.

2) Advance to the next slide or to the next animation effect, press Spacebar.

3) Advance to the next slide without playing object animation effects, press Alt+PageDown.

4) Return to previous slide, press Alt+PageUp.

5) Go to a specific slide, type the page number of the slide and press Enter.

6) Stop slide show, press Esc or -.

Slide Sorter

When you first switch to Slide Sorter view, press Enter to change the keyboard focus to the workspace. Or, press F6 to navigate to the workspace and then press Enter.

Selecting and deselecting slides

1) Use the arrow keys to navigate to the slide that you want to select, and then press

Spacebar.

2) To add to the selection, use the arrow keys to navigate to the slide(s) that you want to add and press Spacebar again.

3) To deselect a slide, navigate to the slide and press Spacebar.

Copying slides

1) Use the arrow keys to navigate to the slide that you want to copy and press Ctrl+C.

2) Move to the slide where you want to paste the copied slide and press Ctrl+V.

Moving slides

1) Use the arrow keys to navigate to the slide that you want to move and press Ctrl+X.

2) Navigate to the slide where you want to move the slide and press Ctrl+V.

3) Select Before or After the current slide and click OK.

Appendix A Keyboard Shortcuts 259

Index

A

accessibility 254 alignment of text 67 alignment tools 118 animation effects multiple 211 properties 209

Arrow styles page 139

Asian language support 105

AutoAbstract 185

AutoLayout 54

B

blink 154 brochure printing 222 bulleted list 69

Bullets and Numbering dialog 71

C

certificate 233 chart entering data 173

Color 95 content boxes (Impress) 27

Create AutoAbstract dialog 185

Create Style dialog 158 crop 98 curve 139

Custom Animation dialog 208 custom slide show 203

D

default formatting 58 default settings 221

Define Custom Slide Show dialog 203

Documentation 9 drawing curve, 110 polygon 110

Drawing toolbar 104

E

e-mail attachment 232

F

features

Impress 14

Fill Format Mode 159 filters 95

Fontwork 126

Fontwork toolbar 127 formatting text 153

Formatting marks 60

Index

G

Gallery

Hide/Show button 89 themes 89 graphic filters 95 graphic styles creating 156 graphics

3D tools 123 interaction 125 rotating 114 grid 119 grid points, color 238

H

handles 42

Handout view 20 handouts automatic layout options 197 creating 196 layout 197 template 197 thumbnails 197

Help system 8

Hide/Show button 89

HTML Export wizard 229 hyperlink inserting 81

I

image map 100

Impress content boxes 27

14

Insert Picture dialog 86 interaction 125

International Support 9

K

keyboard configurations 251 keyboard shortcuts 254 keyboard shortcuts, customizing 249

L

licensing of LibreOffice 12 lines formatting 136

M

macros 251 main Impress window 15

Master Pages 35 master slides 28

Media Playback toolbar 178

Media Player 178

261

N

Navigator 18 non-breaking hyphens 60 non-breaking spaces 60

Normal view 19 notes automatic layout options 193 fields 193 formatting 192

Notes Master 192

Notes view 19, 191, 192, 193, 195 numbered list 69

O

objects converting 124

Open Source Initiative (OSI) 12 outline level 72

Outline view 19, 184, 185

P

Page Setup dialog 187, 193 page style 187 personal key 233

Picture toolbar 93 pictures

AutoLayout 86

Color 95 crop 98 filters 95 resizing 92 rotating 92 transparency 96

Position and Size dialog 43, 113, 115 position of text 64

PowerPoint format save as 234 presentation modifying 29 title slide 26 presentation styles

AutoLayout text box 61

Presentation Wizard 239

Print dialog 218 printing brochure 222

R

Rehearse Timings 206 resizing pictures 92 rotating pictures 92

S

screen settings 187 shapes

3D 123 aligning 118 convert 124

262

shared extension 252 slide master 28 apply 36 author information 44 creat 35 slide show

Custom 203 organizing 200

Rehearse Timings 206 settings 200 timing of automatic slide changes 206

Slide Sorter view 21 slides animations 207 hide 29 layouts 26 master 28 summary slides 184 transitions 204

Slides pane 15 snap guides 119 special characters 59 spreadsheet cells 165 moving 164 styles

Fill Format Mode 159 graphics styles 156

Styles and Formatting dialog 41

Styles and Formatting dialog 41, 156, 157 summary slides 184 support 8 system font 243

T

Tasks pane 16 template description 45 templates create a template folder 50 delete a template folder 51 from other sources 46 importing 51 supplied with LibreOffice 45 text alignment 67 animation 154 bulleted or numbered list 69 character formatting 63 default formatting 58 formatting 60, 153 paragraph formatting 65 pasting 58 position 64 selecting 61 text areas handles 42 text box

LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

AutoLayout 54, 70 moving 55

Text Formatting toolbar 58, 63 text tool 54 themes 89 three-dimensional objects 123 timing of automatic slide changes 206 title slide 26 toolbar 141 toolbars 17 curve, 110 transparencies 152 transparency 96

U

User guides 9 user interface, parts of 10

W

Windows Metafile Format (WMF) 125

Workspace 17

Index 263

264 LibreOffice 4.0 Impress Guide

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement

Table of contents